MITSUBISHI M30220MA

t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Description
Description
The M30220 group of single-chip microcomputers are built using the high-performance silicon gate CMOS
process using a M16C/60 Series CPU core. The M30220 group has LCD controller/driver. M30220 group is
packaged in a 144-pin plastic molded QFP. These single-chip microcomputers operate using sophisticated
instructions featuring a high level of instruction efficiency. With 1M bytes of address space, they are capable of executing instructions at high speed.
Features
• Basic machine instructions .................. Compatible with the M16C/60 series
• Memory capacity .................................. ROM 96 Kbytes
RAM 6 Kbytes
• Shortest instruction execution time ...... 100ns (f(XIN)=10MHz)
• Supply voltage ..................................... 4.0V to 5.5V (f(XIN)=10MHz)
2.7V to 5.5V (f(XIN)=7MHz with software one-wait)
• Interrupts .............................................. 25 internal and 8 external interrupt sources, 4 software, 7 levels
(including key input interrupt)
• Multifunction 16-bit timer ...................... Timer A (output) x 8, timer B (input) x 6
• Real time port outputs .......................... 8 bits X 4 lines
• Serial I/O .............................................. 3 channel for UART or clock synchronous
• DMAC .................................................. 2 channels (trigger: 24 sources)
• A-D converter ....................................... 10 bits X 8 channels
• D-A converter ....................................... 8 bits X 3 channels
• Watchdog timer .................................... 1 line
• Programmable I/O ............................... 104 lines (32 lines are shared with LCD outputs)
_______
• Input port .............................................. 1 line (P77, shared with NMI pin) Specifications written in this manual
• LCD drive control circuit ....................... 1/2, 1/3 bias
are believed to be accurate, but are
not guaranteed to be entirely free of
2, 3 and 4 time sharing
error.
4 common outputs
Specifications in this manual may
48 segment outputs
be changed for functional or
built-in set-up condencer circuit performance improvements. Please
make sure your manual is the latest
• Key input interrupt ................................ 20 lines
edition.
• Clock generating circuit ....................... 2 built-in clock generation circuits
(built-in feedback resistor, and external ceramic or quartz oscillator)
Applications
Camera, Home appliances, Portable equipment, Audio, office equipment, etc.
------Table of Contents-----Central Processing Unit (CPU) ....................... 9
Reset ............................................................. 12
Clock Generating Circuit ............................... 20
Protection ...................................................... 29
Interrupt ......................................................... 30
Watchdog Timer ............................................ 53
DMAC ........................................................... 55
Timer ............................................................. 65
Real time Port ............................................... 85
Serial I/O ....................................................... 87
LCD Drive Control Circuit ............................ 123
A-D Converter ............................................. 130
D-A Converter ............................................. 140
Programmable I/O Port ............................... 142
Electric Characteristics ............................... 155
Flash Memory Version ................................ 168
1
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Description
Pin Configuration
Figure 1.1.1 shows the pin configurations (top view).
108
107
106
105
104
103
102
101
100
99
98
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
SEG19/P103
SEG20/P104
SEG21/P105
SEG22/P106
SEG23/P107
SEG24/P110
SEG25/P111
SEG26/P112
SEG27/P113
SEG28/P114
SEG29/P115
SEG30/P116
SEG31/P117
SEG32/P120
SEG33/P121
VSS
SEG34/P122
VCC
SEG35/P123
SEG36/P124
SEG37/P125
SEG38/P126
SEG39/P127
SEG40/P00
SEG41/P01
SEG42/P02
SEG43/P03
SEG44/P04
SEG45/P05
SEG46/P06
SEG47/P07
P10/KI0
P11/KI1
P12/KI2
P13/KI3
P14/KI4
PIN CONFIGURATION (top view)
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
M30220MX-XXXGP/RP
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
P15/KI5
P16/KI6
P17/KI7
P20/KI8
P21/KI9
P22/KI10
P23/KI11
P24/KI12
P25/KI13
P26/KI14
P27/KI15
P30/KI16
P31/KI17
P32/KI18
P33/KI19
P34
P35
P40/TA0OUT
P41/TA0IN
P42/TA1OUT
P43/TA1IN
P44/TA2OUT
P45/TA2IN
P46/TA3OUT/INT4
P47/TA3IN/INT4
P50/TB0IN
P51/TB1IN
P52/TB2IN
P53/TB3IN
P54/TB4IN
P55/TB5IN
P56/INT3
P57/CKOUT
P60/CTS0/RTS0
P61/CLK0
P62/RxD0
P96/AN6
P95/AN5
P94/AN4
P93/AN3
P92/AN2
P91/AN1
P90/AN0
P87/TA7IN
P86/TA7OUT
P85/TA6IN
P84/TA6OUT
P83/TA5IN
P82/TA5OUT
P81/TA4IN/INT5
P80/TA4OUT/INT5
CNVSS
XCIN
XCOUT
RESET
XOUT
VSS
XIN
VCC
P77/NMI
P76/INT2
P75/INT1
P74/INT0
P73/CTS2/RTS2
P72/CLK2
P71/RXD2/SCL
P70/TXD2/SDA
P67/T xD 1
P66/RxD1
P65/CLK1
P64/CTS1/RTS1/CLKS1
P63/TxD0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
SEG18/P102
SEG17/P101
SEG16/P100
SEG15
SEG14
SEG13
SEG12
SEG11
SEG10
SEG9
SEG8
SEG7
SEG6
SEG5
SEG4
SEG3
SEG2
SEG1
SEG0
COM3
COM2
COM1
COM0
C2
C1
VL3
VL2
VL1
Vss
P132/DA2
P131/DA1
AVSS
P130/ADTRG/DA0
VREF
AVCC
P97/AN7
Package: 144P6Q, 144PFB
Figure 1.1.1. Pin configuration (top view)
2
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Description
Block Diagram
Figure 1.1.2 is a block diagram of the M30220 group.
8
I/O ports
Port P4
8
8
Port P5
1
7
Port P7
Port P6
8
Port P77
Port P8
8
Port P9
M16C/60 series 16-bit CPU core
Registers
R0H
R0L
R0H
R0L
R1H
R1
R1HR
R1L
L
R2
R
2
R3
A
3
AA0
0
A1
F
1B
FB
PC
Stack pointer
ISP
USP
Vector table
INTB
Flag register
FLG
Memory
ROM
(Note 1)
RAM
(Note 2)
AAAA
AAAA
Multiplier
3
SB
Program counter
Port P13
Port P3
Port P2
Port P0
LCD drive control circuit
(4COM X 48SEG)
(8 bits X 3 channels)
8
Port P1
8
UART/clock synchronous SI/O
8
8
8
XIN-XOUT
XCIN-XCOUT
(10 bits X 8 channels
Port P12
D-A converter
(8 bits X 3 channels)
A-D converter
Port P11
Watchdog timer
(15 bits)
DMAC
(2 channels)
8
System clock generator
Timer
Timer TA0 (16 bits)
Timer TA1 (16 bits)
Timer TA2 (16 bits)
Timer TA3 (16 bits)
Timer TA4 (16 bits)
Timer TA5 (16 bits)
Timer TA6 (16 bits)
Timer TA7 (16 bits)
Timer TB0 (16 bits)
Timer TB1 (16 bits)
Timer TB2 (16 bits)
Timer TB3 (16 bits)
Timer TB4 (16 bits)
Timer TB5 (16 bits)
Port P10
6
Internal peripheral functions
Note 1: ROM size depends on MCU type.
Note 2: RAM size depends on MCU type.
Figure 1.1.2. Block diagram of M30220 group
3
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Description
Performance Outline
Table 1.1.1 is performance outline of M30220 group.
Table 1.1.1. Performance outline of M30220 group
Item
Number of basic instructions
Shortest instruction execution time
Memory
ROM
capacity
RAM
I/O port
P0 to P13 (except P77)
Input port
P77
Multifunction TA0 to TA7
timer
TB0 to TB5
Real time port outputs
Serial I/O
UART0 to UART2
A-D converter
D-A converter
DMAC
LCD
COM0 to COM3
SEG0 to SEG47
Watchdog timer
Interrupt
Clock generating circuit
Supply voltage
Power consumption
I/O char- I/O withstand voltage (P0 to P13)
acteristics Output current P1 to P9,P13
P0, P10 to P12
Device configuration
Package
4
Performance
91 instructions
100ns (f(XIN)=10MHz
96 Kbytes
6 Kbytes
8 bits x 11, 3 bits x 1, 6 bits x 1, 7 bits x 1
1 bit x 1
16 bits x 8
16 bits x 6
8 bits x 4 lines
(UART or clock synchronous) x 3
10 bits x 8 channels
8 bits x 3 channels
2 channel(trigger:24 sources)
4 lines
48 lines (32 lines are shared with I/O ports)
15 bits x 1 (with prescaler)
25 internal and 8 external sources, 4 software sources
2 built-in clock generation circuits
(built-in feedback resistor, and external ceramic or
quartz oscillator)
4.5V to 5.5V (f(XIN)=10MHz)
2.7V to 5.5V (f(XIN)=7MHz with software one-wait)
95mW
5V
5 mA
0.1mA("H" output), 2.5mA("L" output)
CMOS silicon gate
144-pin plastic mold QFP
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Description
Mitsubishi plans to release the following products in the M30220 group:
(1) Support for mask ROM version, flash memory version
(2) ROM capacity
(3) Package
144P6Q-A : Plastic molded QFP (mask ROM and flash memory versions)
144PFB-A : Plastic molded QFP(mask ROM and flash memory versions)
Figure 1.1.3 shows the ROM expansion and figure 1.1.4 shows the Type No., memory size, and package.
October. 1999
RAM
(Byte)
Under development
M30220FCGP/RP
10K
Under development
6K
M30220MA-XXXGP/RP
96K
128K
ROM
(Byte)
Figure 1.1.3. ROM expansion
Type No. M30 22 0 M A
- XXX GP
Package type:
GP:
Package144P6Q-A
RP:
144PFB-A
ROM No.
Omitted for flash memory version
Shows characteristic, use
None: General
ROM capacity:
A : 96K bytes
C : 128K bytes
Memory type:
M : Mask ROM version
F : Flash memory version
Shows RAM capacity, pin count, etc.
(The value itself has no specific meaning)
M16C/22 Group(built-in LCD)
M16C Family
Figure 1.1.4. Type No., memory size, and package
5
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Pin Description
Pin Description
Pin name
6
Signal name
I/O
Function
VCC, VSS
Power supply
input
CNVSS
CNVSS
I
Connect it to the VSS pin.
RESET
Reset input
I
A “L” on this input resets the microcomputer.
XIN
Clock input
I
XOUT
Clock output
These pins are provided for the main clock generating circuit.
Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal between the XIN and the
XOUT pins. To use an externally derived clock, input it to the XIN
pin and leave the XOUT pin open.
XCIN
Clock input
I
XCOUT
Clock output
O
AVCC
Analog power
supply input
This pin is a power supply input for the A-D converter. Connect
it to VCC.
AVSS
Analog power
supply input
This pin is a power supply input for the A-D converter. Connect
it to VSS.
VREF
Reference
voltage input
P00 to P07
I/O port P0
I/O
This is an 8-bit CMOS I/O port. It has an input/output port
direction register that allows the user to set each pin for input or
output individually. When set for input, the user can specify in
units of four bits via software whether or not they are tied to a
pull-up resistor. Pins in this port also use as LCD segment
output and real time port output.
P10 to P17
I/O port P1
I/O
This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as input pins for the key input interrupt function and real
time port output.
P20 to P27
I/O port P2
I/O
This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as input pins for the key input interrupt function and real
time port output.
P30 to P35
I/O port P3
I/O
This is a 6-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. P30 to P33 also function
as input pins for the key input interrupt function.
P40 to P47
I/O port P4
I/O
This is a 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as timer A0 to A3 I/O pins, INT4 input pin as selected
by software.
P50 to P57
I/O port P5
I/O
This is a 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as timer B0 to B5 and INT3 input pins, CKOUT output
pin as selected by software.
P60 to P67
I/O port P6
I/O
This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as UART0 and UART1 I/O pins as selected by
software.
Supply 2.7 to 5.5 V to the VCC pin. Supply 0 V to the VSS pin.
O
I
These pins are provided for the sub clock generating circuit.
Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal between the XCIN and the
XCOUT pins. To use an externally derived clock, input it to the
XCIN pin and leave the XCOUT pin open.
This pin is a reference voltage input for the A-D converter.
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Pin Description
Pin Description
Pin name
P70 to P76
Signal name
I/O port P7
P77
I/O
I/O
I
Function
P70 to P76 are I/O ports equivalent to P0 (P70 and P71 are N
channel open-drain output).
Pins in this port also function as UART2 I/O pin, INT0 to INT2
input pins as selected by software.
P77 is an input-only port that also functions for NMI.
P80 to P87
I/O port P8
I/O This is a 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as timer A4 to A7 I/O pins, INT5 input pin as selected by
software.
P90 to P97
I/O port P9
I/O This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as A-D converter analog input pins as selected by
software.
P100 to P107
I/O port P10
I/O This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as SEG output for LCD as selected by software.
P110 to P117
I/O port P11
I/O This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as SEG output for LCD as selected by software.
P120 to P127
I/O port P12
I/O This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as SEG output for LCD and real time port output.
P130 to P132
I/O port P13
I/O
This is an 3-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as D-A converter analog output pins or start trigger for
A-D input pins.
SEG0 to
SEG15
Segment
output
O
Pins in this port function as SEG output for LCD drive circuit.
COM0 to
COM3
Common
output
O
Pins in this port function as common output for LCD drive circuit.
VL1 to VL3
Power supply
input for LCD
Power supply input for LCD drive circuit.
C1, C2
Step-up
condenser
connect port
Pins in this port function as external pin for LCD step-up
condenser. Connect a condenser between C1 and C2.
7
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Memory
Operation of Functional Blocks
The M30220 group accommodates certain units in a single chip. These units include ROM and RAM to
store instructions and data and the central processing unit (CPU) to execute arithmetic/logic operations.
Also included are peripheral units such as timers, real time port, serial I/O, LCD drive control circuit, D-A
converter, A-D converter, DMAC and I/O ports.
The following explains each unit.
Memory
Figure 1.4.1 is a memory map of the M30220 group. The address space extends the 1M bytes from address 0000016 to FFFFF16. From FFFFF16 down is ROM. For example, in the M30220MA-XXXGP, there
is 96K bytes of internal ROM from E800016 to FFFFF16. The vector table for fixed interrupts such as the
_______
reset and NMI are mapped to FFFDC16 to FFFFF16. The starting address of the interrupt routine is stored
here. The address of the vector table for timer interrupts, etc., can be set as desired using the internal
register (INTB). See the section on interrupts for details.
From 0040016 up is RAM. For example, in the M30220MA-XXXGP, 6K bytes of internal RAM is mapped to
the space from 0040016 to 01BFF16. In addition to storing data, the RAM also stores the stack used when
calling subroutines and when interrupts are generated.
The SFR area is mapped to 0000016 to 003FF16. This area accommodates the control registers for peripheral devices such as I/O ports, A-D converter, serial I/O, timers, and LCD, etc. Figures 1.7.1 to 1.7.3 are
location of peripheral unit control registers. Any part of the SFR area that is not occupied is reserved and
cannot be used for other purposes.
The special page vector table is mapped to FFE0016 to FFFDB16. If the starting addresses of subroutines
or the destination addresses of jumps are stored here, subroutine call instructions and jump instructions
can be used as 2-byte instructions, reducing the number of program steps.
0000016
SFR area
For details, see
Figures 1.7.1 to 1.7.3
0040016
Internal RAM area
XXXXX16
FFE0016
Special page
vector table
FFFDC16
Internal RAM area
Undefined instruction
Overflow
BRK instruction
Address match
Single step
Type No.
M30220MA
Address XXXXX16 Address YYYYY16
01BFF16
E800016
Internal ROM area
FFFFF16
Figure 1.4.1. Memory map
8
Watchdog timer
YYYYY16
FFFFF16
DBC
NMI
Reset
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
CPU
Central Processing Unit (CPU)
The CPU has a total of 13 registers shown in Figure 1.5.1. Seven of these registers (R0, R1, R2, R3, A0,
A1, and FB) come in two sets; therefore, these have two register banks.
AAAAAAA
AAAAAAA
AAAAAAA
AAAAAAA
AAAAAAA
b15
R0(Note)
b8 b7
b15
R1(Note)
b15
A0(Note)
b15
FB(Note)
Program counter
Data
registers
b0
b19
INTB
b0
Interrupt table
register
L
H
b15
b0
b0
User stack pointer
USP
b15
b0
b0
b0
PC
b0
Interrupt stack
pointer
ISP
Address
registers
AAAAAAA
AAAAAAA
AAAAAAA
b15
A1(Note)
b19
b0
L
AAAAAAA
AAAAAAA
AAAAAAA
AAAAAAA
b15
R3(Note)
b8 b7
H
b15
R2(Note)
b0
L
H
b15
b0
Static base
register
SB
b15
b0
Frame base
registers
b0
FLG
Flag register
A
AAAAAAA
AA
A
AA
A
AA
AA
AA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AAAAAA
IPL
U
I O B S Z D C
Note: These registers consist of two register banks.
Figure 1.5.1. Central processing unit register
(1) Data registers (R0, R0H, R0L, R1, R1H, R1L, R2, and R3)
Data registers (R0, R1, R2, and R3) are configured with 16 bits, and are used primarily for transfer and
arithmetic/logic operations.
Registers R0 and R1 each can be used as separate 8-bit data registers, high-order bits as (R0H/R1H),
and low-order bits as (R0L/R1L). In some instructions, registers R2 and R0, as well as R3 and R1 can
use as 32-bit data registers (R2R0/R3R1).
(2) Address registers (A0 and A1)
Address registers (A0 and A1) are configured with 16 bits, and have functions equivalent to those of data
registers. These registers can also be used for address register indirect addressing and address register
relative addressing.
In some instructions, registers A1 and A0 can be combined for use as a 32-bit address register (A1A0).
9
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
CPU
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
(3) Frame base register (FB)
Frame base register (FB) is configured with 16 bits, and is used for FB relative addressing.
(4) Program counter (PC)
Program counter (PC) is configured with 20 bits, indicating the address of an instruction to be executed.
(5) Interrupt table register (INTB)
Interrupt table register (INTB) is configured with 20 bits, indicating the start address of an interrupt vector
table.
(6) Stack pointer (USP/ISP)
Stack pointer comes in two types: user stack pointer (USP) and interrupt stack pointer (ISP), each configured with 16 bits.
Your desired type of stack pointer (USP or ISP) can be selected by a stack pointer select flag (U flag).
This flag is located at the position of bit 7 in the flag register (FLG).
(7) Static base register (SB)
Static base register (SB) is configured with 16 bits, and is used for SB relative addressing.
(8) Flag register (FLG)
Flag register (FLG) is configured with 11 bits, each bit is used as a flag. Figure 1.5.2 shows the flag
register (FLG). The following explains the function of each flag:
• Bit 0: Carry flag (C flag)
This flag retains a carry, borrow, or shift-out bit that has occurred in the arithmetic/logic unit.
• Bit 1: Debug flag (D flag)
This flag enables a single-step interrupt.
When this flag is “1”, a single-step interrupt is generated after instruction execution. This flag is
cleared to “0” when the interrupt is acknowledged.
• Bit 2: Zero flag (Z flag)
This flag is set to “1” when an arithmetic operation resulted in 0; otherwise, cleared to “0”.
• Bit 3: Sign flag (S flag)
This flag is set to “1” when an arithmetic operation resulted in a negative value; otherwise, cleared to “0”.
• Bit 4: Register bank select flag (B flag)
This flag chooses a register bank. Register bank 0 is selected when this flag is “0” ; register bank 1 is
selected when this flag is “1”.
• Bit 5: Overflow flag (O flag)
This flag is set to “1” when an arithmetic operation resulted in overflow; otherwise, cleared to “0”.
• Bit 6: Interrupt enable flag (I flag)
This flag enables a maskable interrupt.
An interrupt is disabled when this flag is “0”, and is enabled when this flag is “1”. This flag is cleared to
“0” when the interrupt is acknowledged.
10
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
CPU
• Bit 7: Stack pointer select flag (U flag)
Interrupt stack pointer (ISP) is selected when this flag is “0” ; user stack pointer (USP) is selected
when this flag is “1”.
This flag is cleared to “0” when a hardware interrupt is acknowledged or an INT instruction of software
interrupt Nos. 0 to 31 is executed.
• Bits 8 to 11: Reserved area
• Bits 12 to 14: Processor interrupt priority level (IPL)
Processor interrupt priority level (IPL) is configured with three bits, for specification of up to eight
processor interrupt priority levels from level 0 to level 7.
If a requested interrupt has priority greater than the processor interrupt priority level (IPL), the interrupt
is enabled.
• Bit 15: Reserved area
The C, Z, S, and O flags are changed when instructions are executed. See the software manual for
details.
AA
AAAAAAA
AA
AA
A
AA
AA
AA
A
AA
AA
AAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
AA
AA
A
AA
b15
b0
IPL
U
I
O B S Z D C
Flag register (FLG)
Carry flag
Debug flag
Zero flag
Sign flag
Register bank select flag
Overflow flag
Interrupt enable flag
Stack pointer select flag
Reserved area
Processor interrupt priority level
Reserved area
Figure 1.5.2. Flag register (FLG)
11
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Reset
Reset
There are two kinds of resets; hardware and software. In both cases, operation is the same after the reset.
(See “Software Reset” for details of software resets.) This section explains on hardware resets.
When the supply voltage is in the range where operation is guaranteed, a reset is effected by holding the
reset pin level “L” (0.2VCC max.) for at least 20 cycles. When the reset pin level is then returned to the “H”
level while main clock is stable, the reset status is cancelled and program execution resumes from the
address in the reset vector table.
Figure 1.6.1 shows the example reset circuit. Figure 1.6.2 shows the reset sequence.
5V
4.0V
VCC
0V
RESET
VCC
5V
RESET
0.8V
0V
Figure 1.6.1. Example reset circuit
XIN
More than 20 cycles are needed
RESET
BCLK 24 cycles
BCLK
Content of reset vector
FFFFC16
Address
(Internal Address signal)
FFFFE16
Figure 1.6.2. Reset sequence
____________
Table 1.6.1 shows the statuses of the other pins while the RESET pin level is “L”. Figures 1.6.3 and 1.6.4
show the internal status of the microcomputer immediately after the reset is cancelled.
____________
Table 1.6.1. Pin status when RESET pin level is “L”
Status
Pin name
12
P0, P10 to P12
Input port(with a pull up resistor)
P1 to P9, P13
Input port (floating)
SEG0 to SEG15
“H” level is output
COM0 to COM3
“H” level is output
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Reset
(1)Processor mode register 0
(000416)•••
(2)Processor mode register 1
(000516)•••
0 0 0 0
0
0 0
(27)UART1 transmit interrupt control register
(005316)•••
? 0 0 0
(28)UART1 receive interrupt control register
(005416)•••
? 0 0 0
(3)System clock control register 0
(000616)•••
0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0
(29)Timer A0 interrupt control register
(005516)•••
? 0 0 0
(4)System clock control register 1
(000716)•••
0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0
(30)Timer A1 interrupt control register
(005616)•••
? 0 0 0
(5)Address match interrupt enable register
(000916)•••
0 0
(31)Timer A2 interrupt control register
(005716)•••
? 0 0 0
(6)Protect register
(000A16)•••
0 0
(32)Timer A3 interrupt control register
(005816)•••
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(7)Watchdog timer control register
(000F16)•••
0 0 0 ? ? ? ? ?
(33)Timer A4 interrupt control register
(005916)•••
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(001016)•••
0016
(34)Timer B0 interrupt control register
(005A16)•••
? 0 0 0
(001116)•••
0016
(35)Timer B1 interrupt control register
(005B16)•••
? 0 0 0
(36)Timer B2 interrupt control register
(005C16)•••
? 0 0 0
(37)INT0 interrupt control register
(005D16)•••
0 0 ? 0 0 0
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(8)Address match interrupt register 0
(001216)•••
(9)Address match interrupt register 1
0 0 0 0
(001416)•••
0016
(001516)•••
0016
(38)INT1 interrupt control register
(005E16)•••
(39)INT2 interrupt control register
(005F16)•••
0 0 0 0 0 ? 0 0
(40)LCD mode register
(012016)•••
0
(003C16)•••
0 0 0 0 0 ? 0 0
(41)Segment output enable register
(012216)•••
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
(001616)•••
0 0 0 0
(10)DMA0 control register
(002C16)•••
(11)DMA1 control register
0 0 ? 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0
(12)INT3 interrupt control register
(004416)•••
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(42)Key input mode register
(012616)•••
0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0
(13)Timer B5 interrupt control register
(004516)•••
? 0 0 0
(43)Count start flag 1
(034016)•••
0 0 0
0 0 0
(14)Timer B4 interrupt control register
(004616)•••
? 0 0 0
(44)One-shot start flag 1
(034216)•••
0 0
0 0 0
(15)Timer B3 interrupt control register
(004716)•••
? 0 0 0
(45)Trigger select flag 1
(034316)•••
(16)Timer A7 interrupt control register
(004816)•••
? 0 0 0
(46)Up-down flag 1
(034416)•••
(17)Timer A6 interrupt control register
(004916)•••
? 0 0 0
(47)Timer A5 mode register
(035616)•••
0016
(18)Timer A5 interrupt control register
(004A16)•••
? 0 0 0
(48)Timer A6 mode register
(035716)•••
0016
(19)DMA0 interrupt control register
(004B16)•••
? 0 0 0
(49)Timer A7 mode register
(035816)•••
(20)DMA1 interrupt control register
(004C16)•••
? 0 0 0
(50)Timer B3 mode register
(035B16)•••
0 0 ?
0 0 0 0
(21)Key input interrupt control register
(004D16)•••
? 0 0 0
(51)Timer B4 mode register
(035C16)•••
0 0 ?
0 0 0 0
(22)A-D conversion interrupt control register
(004E16)•••
? 0 0 0
(52)Timer B5 mode register
(035D16)•••
0 0 ?
0 0 0 0
(23)UART2 transmit interrupt control register
(004F16)•••
? 0 0 0
(53)Interrupt cause select register 0
(035E16)•••
(24)UART2 receive interrupt control register
(005016)•••
? 0 0 0
(54)Interrupt cause select register 1
(035F16)•••
(25)UART0 transmit interrupt control register
(005116)•••
? 0 0 0
(55)Clock division counter control register
(036016)•••
(26)UART0 receive interrupt control register
(005216)•••
? 0 0 0
(56)UART2 special mode register 2
(037616)•••
0016
(57)UART2 special mode register
(037716)•••
0016
(58)UART2 transmit/receive mode register
(037816)•••
0016
0 0 0 0
0 0 0
0
0016
0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0016
0
The content of other registers and RAM is undefined when the microcomputer is
reset. The initial values must therefore be set.
x : Nothing is mapped to this bit
? : Undefined
Figure 1.6.3. Device's internal status after a reset is cleared
13
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Reset
(85)A-D control register 0
(03D616)· · ·
(60)UART2 transmit/receive control register 1 (037D16)· · · 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
(86)A-D control register 1
(03D716)· · ·
(87)D-A control register
(03DC16)· · ·
(88)Port P0 direction register
(03E216)· · ·
(89)Port P1 direction register
(03E316)· · ·
0016
0016
0016
(61)Count start flag 0
(038016)· · ·
(62) Clock prescaler reset flag
(038116)· · · 0
(63)One-shot start flag 0
(038216)· · · 0 0
0 0 0 0 0
0016
0 0 0
0016
(64)Trigger select flag 0
(038316)· · ·
0016
(90)Port P2 direction register
(03E616)· · ·
(65)Up-down flag 0
(038416)· · ·
0016
(91)Port P3 direction register
(03E716)· · ·
(66)Timer A0 mode register
(039616)· · ·
0016
(92)Port P4 direction register
(03EA16)· · ·
0016
(67)Timer A1 mode register
(039716)· · ·
0016
(93)Port P5 direction register
(03EB16)· · ·
0016
(68)Timer A2 mode register
(039816)· · ·
0016
(94)Port P6 direction register
(03EE16)· · ·
0016
(69)Timer A3 mode register
(039916)· · ·
0016
(95)Port P7 direction register
(03EF16)· · ·
(70)Timer A4 mode register
(039A16)· · ·
0016
(96)Port P8 direction register
(03F216)· · ·
0016
(71)Timer B0 mode register
(039B16)· · · 0 0 ?
0 0 0 0
(97)Port P9 direction register
(03F316)· · ·
0016
(72)Timer B1 mode register
(039C16)· · · 0 0 ?
0 0 0 0
(98)Port P10 direction register
(03F616)· · ·
0016
(73)Timer B2 mode register
(039D16)· · · 0 0 ?
0 0 0 0
(99)Port P11 direction register
(03F716)· · ·
0016
(74)UART0 transmit/receive mode register
(03A016)· · ·
(100)Port P12 direction register
(03FA16)· · ·
0016
(75)UART0 transmit/receive control register 0 (03A416)· · · 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
(101)Port P13 direction register
(03FB16)· · ·
(76)UART0 transmit/receive control register 1 (03A516)· · · 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
(102)Pull-up control register 0
(03FC16)· · · 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1
(103)Pull-up control register 1
(03FD16)· · ·
(78)UART1 transmit/receive control register 0 (03AC16)· · · 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
(104)Pull-up control register 2
(03FE16)· · · 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0
(79)UART1 transmit/receive control register 1 (03AD16)· · · 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
(105)Real time port control register
(03FF16)· · ·
(106)Data registers (R0/R1/R2/R3)
···
000016
(107)Address registers (A0/A1)
···
000016
(108)Frame base register (FB)
···
000016
(77)UART1 transmit/receive mode register
(80)UART transmit/receive control register 2
(03A816)· · ·
(03B016)· · ·
(81)Flash memory control register (Note) (03B416)· · ·
0016
0016
0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0
(82)DMA0 cause select register
(03B816)· · ·
0016
(83)DMA1 cause select register
(03BA16)· · ·
0016
(84) A-D control register 2
(03D416)· · ·
0 1
0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0
0016
0016
(109)Interrupt table register (INTB)
···
0000016
(110)User stack pointer (USP)
···
000016
(111)Interrupt stack pointer (ISP)
···
000016
(112)Static base register (SB)
···
000016
(113)Flag register (FLG)
···
000016
x : Nothing is mapped to this bit
? : Undefined
The content of other registers and RAM is undefined when the microcomputer is reset. The initial values
must therefore be set.
Note : This register is only exist in flash memory version.
Figure 1.6.4. Device's internal status after a reset is cleared
14
0 0 0 ? ? ?
(59)UART2 transmit/receive control register 0 (037C16)· · · 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
SFR
004016
000016
004116
000116
004216
000216
004316
004416
000316
000416
000516
000616
000716
Processor mode register 0 (PM0)
Processor mode register 1(PM1)
System clock control register 0 (CM0)
System clock control register 1 (CM1)
000A16
004616
004716
004816
004916
000816
000916
004516
Address match interrupt enable register (AIER)
Protect register (PRCR)
004A16
000B16
004B16
000C16
004C16
004D16
000D16
000E16
000F16
Watchdog timer start register (WDTS)
Watchdog timer control register (WDC)
004F16
005016
001016
001116
004E16
Address match interrupt register 0 (RMAD0)
005116
001216
005216
001316
005316
005416
001416
001516
Address match interrupt register 1 (RMAD1)
005516
001616
005616
001716
005716
001816
005816
001916
005916
001A16
001B16
001C16
005A16
001D16
005B16
001E16
005C16
001F16
005D16
005E16
002016
002116
DMA0 source pointer (SAR0)
005F16
INT3 interrupt control register (INT3IC)
Timer B5 interrupt control register (TB5IC)
Timer B4 interrupt control register (TB4IC)
Timer B3 interrupt control register (TB3IC)
Timer A7 interrupt control register (TA7IC)
Timer A6 interrupt control register (TA6IC)
Timer A5 interrupt control register (TA5IC)
Bus collision detection interrupt control register (BCNIC)
DMA0 interrupt control register (DM0IC)
DMA1 interrupt control register (DM1IC)
Key input interrupt control register (KUPIC)
A-D conversion interrupt control register (ADIC)
UART2 transmit interrupt control register (S2TIC)
UART2 receive interrupt control register (S2RIC)
UART0 transmit interrupt control register (S0TIC)
UART0 receive interrupt control register (S0RIC)
UART1 transmit interrupt control register (S1TIC)
UART1 receive interrupt control register (S1RIC)
Timer A0 interrupt control register (TA0IC)
Timer A1 interrupt control register (TA1IC)
Timer A2 interrupt control register (TA2IC)
Timer A3 interrupt control register (TA3IC)
INT4 interrupt control register (INT4IC)
Timer A4 interrupt control register (TA4IC)
INT5 interrupt control register (INT5IC)
Timer B0 interrupt control register (TB0IC)
Timer B1 interrupt control register (TB1IC)
Timer B2 interrupt control register (TB2IC)
INT0 interrupt control register (INT0IC)
INT1 interrupt control register (INT1IC)
INT2 interrupt control register (INT2IC)
002216
002316
010016
002416
010116
002516
DMA0 destination pointer (DAR0)
011716
LCD RAM0(LRAM0)
LCD RAM1(LRAM1)
LCD RAM2(LRAM2)
LCD RAM3(LRAM3)
LCD RAM4(LRAM4)
LCD RAM5(LRAM5)
LCD RAM6(LRAM6)
LCD RAM7(LRAM7)
LCD RAM8(LRAM8)
LCD RAM9(LRAM9)
LCD RAM10(LRAM10)
LCD RAM11(LRAM11)
LCD RAM12(LRAM12)
LCD RAM13(LRAM13)
LCD RAM14(LRAM14)
LCD RAM15(LRAM15)
LCD RAM16(LRAM16)
LCD RAM17(LRAM17)
LCD RAM18(LRAM18)
LCD RAM19(LRAM19)
LCD RAM20(LRAM20)
LCD RAM21(LRAM21)
LCD RAM22(LRAM22)
LCD RAM23(LRAM23)
012016
LCD mode register (LCDM)
010216
002616
010316
002716
010416
002816
DMA0 transfer counter (TCR0)
010516
002916
010616
002A16
010716
010816
002B16
002C16
DMA0 control register (DM0CON)
010916
002D16
010A16
002E16
010B16
002F16
010C16
010D16
003016
003116
DMA1 source pointer (SAR1)
010E16
003216
010F16
003316
011016
011116
003416
003516
DMA1 destination pointer (DAR1)
011216
003616
011316
003716
011416
003816
003916
011516
DMA1 transfer counter (TCR1)
003A16
011616
003B16
003C16
DMA1 control register (DM1CON)
003D16
012116
003E16
012216
003F16
012316
012416
Segment output enable register (SEG)
LCD frame frequency counter (LCDTIM)
012516
012616
Key input mode register (KUPM)
Figure 1.7.1. Location of peripheral unit control registers (1)
15
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
SFR
034016
Count start flag 1 (TABSR1)
034116
034216
034316
034416
038116
One-shot start flag 1 (ONSF1)
Trigger select register 1 (TRGSR1)
Up-down flag 1(UDF1)
034516
034616
034716
034816
034916
034A16
034B16
038016
038216
038316
038416
038516
Timer A5 (TA5)
038616
038716
Timer A6 (TA6)
038816
Timer A7 (TA7)
038A16
038916
038B16
034C16
038C16
034D16
038D16
034E16
038E16
034F16
038F16
035016
035116
035216
035316
035416
035516
035616
035716
035816
Timer B3 (TB3)
Timer B4 (TB4)
035D16
035E16
035F16
039216
039316
Timer B5 (TB5)
039416
Timer A5 mode register (TA5MR)
Timer A6 mode register (TA6MR)
Timer A7 mode register (TA7MR)
039616
039516
039716
039816
039916
035A16
035C16
039016
039116
035916
035B16
039A16
Timer B3 mode register (TB3MR)
Timer B4 mode register (TB4MR)
Timer B5 mode register(TB5MR)
Interrupt cause select register 0 (IFSR0)
Interrupt cause select register 1 (IFSR1)
Clock division counter control register (CDCC)
039B16
039C16
039D16
Timer A0 (TA0)
Timer A1 (TA1)
Timer A2 (TA2)
Timer A3 (TA3)
Timer A4 (TA4)
Timer B0 (TB0)
Timer B1 (TB1)
Timer B2 (TB2)
Timer A0 mode register (TA0MR)
Timer A1 mode register (TA1MR)
Timer A2 mode register (TA2MR)
Timer A3 mode register (TA3MR)
Timer A4 mode register (TA4MR)
Timer B0 mode register (TB0MR)
Timer B1 mode register (TB1MR)
Timer B2 mode register (TB2MR)
039E16
039F16
03A016
UART0 transmit/receive mode register (U0MR)
036116
03A116
UART0 bit rate generator (U0BRG)
036216
03A216
036316
03A316
UART0 transmit buffer register (U0TB)
036416
03A416
036516
03A516
036616
03A616
036716
03A716
036816
03A816
UART1 transmit/receive mode register (U1MR)
036916
03A916
UART1 bit rate generator (U1BRG)
036A16
03AA16
036B16
UART1 transmit buffer register (U1TB)
03AB16
036C16
03AC16
036D16
03AD16
036016
036E16
Clock division counter (CDC)
03AE16
036F16
03AF16
037016
03B016
037116
03B116
037216
03B216
037316
03B316
037416
03B416
037516
03B516
037616
037716
037816
037916
037A16
037B16
037C16
037D16
037E16
037F16
UART2 special mode register 2(U2SMR2)
UART2 special mode register (U2SMR)
03B616
UART2 transmit/receive mode register (U2MR)
UART2 bit rate generator (U2BRG)
03B816
UART2 transmit buffer register (U2TB)
03BA16
UART0 transmit/receive control register 0 (U0C0)
UART0 transmit/receive control register 1 (U0C1)
UART0 receive buffer register (U0RB)
UART1 transmit/receive control register 0 (U1C0)
UART1 transmit/receive control register 1 (U1C1)
UART1 receive buffer register (U1RB)
UART transmit/receive control register 2 (UCON)
Flash memory control register (FMCR)(Note)
03B716
DMA0 request cause select register (DM0SL)
03B916
03BB16
UART2 transmit/receive control register 0 (U2C0)
UART2 transmit/receive control register 1 (U2C1)
03BC16
UART2 receive buffer register (U2RB)
03BE16
03BD16
03BF16
Note : This register is only exist in flash memory version.
Figure 1.7.2. Location of peripheral unit control registers (2)
16
Count start flag 0 (TABSR0)
Clock prescaler reset flag (CPSRF)
One-shot start flag 0 (ONSF0)
Trigger select register 0 (TRGSR0)
Up-down flag 0 (UDF0)
DMA1 request cause select register (DM1SL)
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
SFR
03C016
03C116
03C216
03C316
03C416
03C516
03C616
03C716
03C816
03C916
03CA16
03CB16
03CC16
03CD16
03CE16
03CF16
A-D register 0 (AD0)
A-D register 1 (AD1)
A-D register 2 (AD2)
A-D register 3 (AD3)
A-D register 4 (AD4)
A-D register 5 (AD5)
A-D register 6 (AD6)
A-D register 7 (AD7)
03D016
03D116
03D216
03D316
03D416
A-D control register 2 (ADCON2)
03D516
03D616
03D716
03D816
A-D control register 0 (ADCON0)
A-D control register 1 (ADCON1)
D-A register 0 (DA0)
03D916
03DA16
D-A register 1 (DA1)
03DB16
03DC16
D-A control register (DACON)
03DD16
03DE16
D-A register 2 (DA2)
03DF16
03E016
03E116
03E216
03E316
03E416
03E516
03E616
03E716
03E816
03E916
03EA16
03EB16
03EC16
03ED16
03EE16
03EF16
03F016
03F116
03F216
03F316
03F416
03F516
03F616
03F716
03F816
03F916
03FA16
03FB16
03FC16
03FD16
03FE16
03FF16
Port P0 (P0)
Port P1 (P1)
Port P0 direction register (PD0)
Port P1 direction register (PD1)
Port P2 (P2)
Port P3 (P3)
Port P2 direction register (PD2)
Port P3 direction register (PD3)
Port P4 (P4)
Port P5 (P5)
Port P4 direction register (PD4)
Port P5 direction register (PD5)
Port P6 (P6)
Port P7 (P7)
Port P6 direction register (PD6)
Port P7 direction register (PD7)
Port P8 (P8)
Port P9 (P9)
Port P8 direction register (PD8)
Port P9 direction register (PD9)
Port P10 (P10)
Port P11 (P11)
Port P10 direction register (PD10)
Port P11 direction register (PD11)
Port P12 (P12)
Port P13 (P13)
Port P12 direction register (PD12)
Port P13 direction register (PD13)
Pull-up control register 0 (PUR0)
Pull-up control register 1 (PUR1)
Pull-up control register 2 (PUR2)
Real time port control register (RTP)
Figure 1.7.3. Location of peripheral unit control registers (3)
17
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Software Reset
Software Reset
Writing “1” to bit 3 of the processor mode register 0 (address 000416) applies a (software) reset to the
microcomputer. A software reset has the same effect as a hardware reset. The contents of internal RAM
are preserved.
Figure 1.8.1 shows the processor mode register 0 and 1.
Processor mode register 0 (Note)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
0
Symbol
PM0
Address
000416
Bit symbol
Bit name
Reserved bit
PM03
When reset
XXXX00002
Function
Must always be set to “0”
Software reset bit
The device is reset when this bit
is set to “1”. The value of this bit
is “0” when read.
Nothing is assigned.
A
A
A
R W
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns
out to be indeterminate.
Note: Set bit 1 of the protect register (address 000A16) to “1” when writing new
values to this register.
Processor mode register 1 (Note)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
0
Symbol
PM1
Address
000516
Bit symbol
Bit name
When reset
0XXXXX002
Function
Must always be set to “0”
Reserved bit
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns
out to be indeterminate.
PM17
Wait bit
0 : No wait state
1 : Wait state inserted
A
A
A
R W
Note: Set bit 1 of the protect register (address 000A16) to “1” when writing new values
to this register.
Figure 1.8.1. Processor mode register 0 and 1
18
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Software Wait
Software wait
A software wait can be inserted by setting the wait bit (bit 7) of the processor mode register 1 (address
000516). (Note)
A software wait is inserted in the internal ROM/RAM area. When set to “0”, each bus cycle is executed in
one BCLK cycle. When set to “1”, each bus cycle is executed in two BCLK cycles. After the microcomputer
has been reset, this bit defaults to “0”. Set this bit after referring to the recommended operating conditions
(main clock input oscillation frequency) of the electric characteristics.
The SFR area is always accessed in two BCLK cycles regardless of the setting of this control bit.
Table 1.8.1 shows the software waits and bus cycles.
Note: Before attempting to change the contents of the processor mode register 1, set bit 1 of the protect
register (address 000A16) to “1”.
Table 1.8.1. Software waits and bus cycles
Bus cycle
Area
Wait bit
SFR
Invalid
2 BCLK cycles
0
1 BCLK cycle
1
2 BCLK cycles
Internal
ROM/RAM
19
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock Generating Circuit
Clock Generating Circuit
The clock generating circuit contains two oscillator circuits that supply the operating clock sources to the
CPU and internal peripheral units.
Table 1.9.1. Main clock and sub-clock generating circuits
Main clock generating circuit
• CPU’s operating clock source
• Internal peripheral units’
operating clock source
Use of clock
Sub-clock generating circuit
• CPU’s operating clock source
• Timer A/B’s count clock
source
• Intermittent pullup operation
clock source of key input
• LCD operation clock source
Crystal oscillator
XCIN, XCOUT
Available
Stopped
Usable oscillator
Pins to connect oscillator
Oscillation stop/restart function
Oscillator status immediately after reset
Ceramic or crystal oscillator
XIN, XOUT
Available
Oscillating
Other
Externally derived clock can be input
Example of oscillator circuit
Figure 1.9.1 shows some examples of the main clock circuit, one using an oscillator connected to the
circuit, and the other one using an externally derived clock for input. Figure 1.9.2 shows some examples of
sub-clock circuits, one using an oscillator connected to the circuit, and the other one using an externally
derived clock for input. Circuit constants in Figures 1.9.1 and 1.9.2 vary with each oscillator used. Use the
values recommended by the manufacturer of your oscillator.
Microcomputer
Microcomputer
(Built-in feedback resistor)
(Built-in feedback resistor)
XIN
XOUT
XIN
XOUT
Open
(Note)
Rd
Externally derived clock
CIN
COUT
Vcc
Vss
Note: Insert a damping resistor if required. The resistance will vary depending on the oscillator and the oscillation drive
capacity setting. Use the value recommended by the maker of the oscillator.
When the oscillation drive capacity is set to low, check that oscillation is stable. Also, if the oscillator manufacturer's
data sheet specifies that a feedback resistor be added external to the chip, insert a feedback resistor between XIN
and XOUT following the instruction.
Figure 1.9.1. Examples of main clock
Microcomputer
Microcomputer
(Built-in feedback resistor)
(Built-in feedback resistor)
XCIN
XCOUT
XCIN
XCOUT
Open
(Note)
RCd
Externally derived clock
CCIN
CCOUT
Vcc
Vss
Note: Insert a damping resistor if required. The resistance will vary depending on the oscillator and the oscillation drive
capacity setting. Use the value recommended by the maker of the oscillator.
When the oscillation drive capacity is set to low, check that oscillation is stable. Also, if the oscillator manufacturer's
data sheet specifies that a feedback resistor be added external to the chip, insert a feedback resistor between XCIN
and XCOUT following the instruction.
Figure 1.9.2. Examples of sub-clock
20
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock Generating Circuit
Clock Control
Figure 1.9.3 shows the block diagram of the clock generating circuit.
CM14=1
fC1
XCIN
fC132
1/32
XCOUT
CM14=0
fC32
f1
CM04
fAD
fC
f8
Sub clock
CM10 “1”
Write signal
S Q
XIN
XOUT
a
RESET
Software reset
Main clock
CM02
CM05
NMI
Interrupt request
level judgment
output
AAA
AAA
AAA
b
R
f32
c
Divider
d
CM07=0
BCLK
fC
CM07=1
S Q
WAIT instruction
R
c
b
a
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
CM06=0
CM17,CM16=11
CM06=1
CM06=0
CM17,CM16=10
d
CM06=0
CM17,CM16=01
CM06=0
CM17,CM16=00
CM0i : Bit i at address 000616
CM1i : Bit i at address 000716
WDCi : Bit i at address 000F16
Details of divider
Figure 1.9.3. Clock generating circuit
21
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Clock Generating Circuit
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
The following paragraphs describes the clocks generated by the clock generating circuit.
(1) Main clock
The main clock is generated by the main clock oscillation circuit. After a reset, the clock is divided by 8 to
the BCLK. The clock can be stopped using the main clock stop bit (bit 5 at address 000616). Stopping the
clock, after switching the operating clock source of CPU to the sub-clock, reduces the power dissipation.
After the oscillation of the main clock oscillation circuit has stabilized, the drive capacity of the main clock
oscillation circuit can be reduced using the XIN-XOUT drive capacity select bit (bit 5 at address 000716).
Reducing the drive capacity of the main clock oscillation circuit reduces the power dissipation. This bit
changes to “1” when shifting from high-speed/medium-speed mode to stop mode and at a reset. When
shifting from low-speed/low power dissipation mode to stop mode, the value before stop mode is retained.
(2) Sub-clock
The sub-clock is generated by the sub-clock oscillation circuit. No sub-clock is generated after a reset.
After oscillation is started using the port Xc select bit (bit 4 at address 000616), the sub-clock can be
selected as the BCLK by using the system clock select bit (bit 7 at address 000616). However, be sure
that the sub-clock oscillation has fully stabilized before switching.
After the oscillation of the sub-clock oscillation circuit has stabilized, the drive capacity of the sub-clock
oscillation circuit can be reduced using the XCIN-XCOUT drive capacity select bit (bit 3 at address 000616).
Reducing the drive capacity of the sub-clock oscillation circuit reduces the power dissipation. This bit
changes to “1” when shifting to stop mode and at a reset.
(3) BCLK
The BCLK is the clock that drives the CPU, and is fc or the clock is derived by dividing the main clock by
1, 2, 4, 8, or 16. The BCLK is derived by dividing the main clock by 8 after a reset.
The main clock division select bit 0(bit 6 at address 000616) changes to “1” when shifting from highspeed/medium-speed to stop mode and at reset. When shifting from low-speed/low power dissipation
mode to stop mode, the value before stop mode is retained.
(4) Peripheral function clock (f1, f8, f32, fAD)
The clock for the peripheral devices is derived from the main clock or by dividing it by 1, 8, or 32. The
peripheral function clock is stopped by stopping the main clock or by setting the WAIT peripheral function
clock stop bit (bit 2 at 000616) to “1” and then executing a WAIT instruction.
(5) fC132
This clock is derived by dividing the sub-clock by 1 or 32. The clock is selected by fC132 clock select bit
(bit4 at address 000716). It is used for the timer A and timer B counts, intermittent pull up operation of key
input.
(6) fC
This clock has the same frequency as the sub-clock. It is used for the BCLK and for the watchdog timer.
22
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock Generating Circuit
Figure 1.9.4 shows the system clock control registers 0 and 1.
System clock control register 0 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
CM0
Address
000616
Bit symbol
When reset
4816
Bit name
Function
b1 b0
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
RW
Clock output function
select bit
0 0 : I/O port P57
0 1 : fC1 output
1 0 : f1 output
1 1 : Clock divide counter output
WAIT peripheral function
clock stop bit
XCIN-XCOUT drive capacity
select bit (Note 2)
0 : Do not stop peripheral function clock in wait mode
1 : Stop peripheral function clock in wait mode (Note 8)
0 : LOW
1 : HIGH
CM04
Sub clock (XCIN-XCOUT)
oscillation enable bit
0 : Off
1 : On
CM05
Main clock (XIN-XOUT)
stop bit (Note 3, 4, 5)
0 : On
1 : Off
CM06
Main clock division select
bit 0 (Note 7)
0 : CM16 and CM17 valid
1 : Division by 8 mode
CM07
System clock select bit
(Note 6)
0 : XIN, XOUT
1 : XCIN, XCOUT
CM00
CM01
CM02
CM03
Note 1: Set bit 0 of the protect register (address 000A16) to “1” before writing to this register.
Note 2: Changes to “1” when shifting to stop mode and at a reset.
Note 3: When entering power saving mode, main clock stops using this bit. When returning from stop mode and
operating with XIN, set this bit to “0”. When main clock oscillation is operating by itself, set system clock select
bit (CM07) to “1” before setting this bit to “1”.
Note 4: When inputting external clock, only clock oscillation buffer is stopped and clock input is acceptable.
Note 5: If this bit is set to “1”, XOUT turns “H”. The built-in feedback resistor remains being connected, so XIN turns
pulled up to XOUT (“H”) via the feedback resistor.
Note 6: Sub clock (XCIN-XCOUT) oscillation enable bit (CM04) to “1” and stabilize the sub-clock oscillating before setting
to this bit from “0” to “1”. Do not write to both bits at the same time. And also, set the main clock stop bit (CM05)
to “0” and stabilize the main clock oscillating before setting this bit from “1” to “0”.
Note 7: This bit changes to “1” when shifting from high-speed/medium-speed mode to stop mode and at a reset. When
shifting from low-speed/low power dissipation mode to stop mode, the value before stop mode is retained.
Note 8: fC, fC132, fC1, fC32 is not included.
System clock control register 1 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
0
0
0
b0
Symbol
CM1
Address
000716
Bit symbol
CM10
When reset
2016
Bit name
All clock stop control bit
(Note 4)
Function
0 : Clock on
1 : All clocks off (stop mode)
Reserved bit
Always set to “0”
Reserved bit
Always set to “0”
Reserved bit
Always set to “0”
fC132 clock select bit
0 : fC32
1 : fC1
CM15
XIN-XOUT drive capacity
select bit (Note 2)
0 : LOW
1 : HIGH
CM16
Main clock division
select bit 1 (Note 3)
CM14
b7 b6
CM17
0 0 : No division mode
0 1 : Division by 2 mode
1 0 : Division by 4 mode
1 1 : Division by 16 mode
AA
AA
AA
AAAA
AA
AA
AAAA
RW
Note 1: Set bit 0 of the protect register (address 000A16) to “1” before writing to this register.
Note 2: This bit changes to “1” when shifting from high-speed/medium-speed mode to stop mode and at a reset. When
shifting from low-speed/low power dissipation mode to stop mode, the value before stop mode is retained.
Note 3: Can be selected when bit 6 of the system clock control register 0 (address 000616) is “0”. If “1”, division mode is
fixed at 8.
Note 4: If this bit is set to “1”, XOUT turns “H”, and the built-in feedback resistor is cut off. XCIN and XCOUT turn highimpedance state.
Figure 1.9.4. Clock control registers 0 and 1
23
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock Output
Clock Output
The clock output function select bit allows you to choose the clock from f1, fC1, or a divide-by-n clock that is
output from the P57/CKOUT pin. The clock divide counter is an 8-bit counter whose count source is f32, and
its divide ratio can be set in the range of 0016 to FF16. Also, the clock divided counter can be controlled for
start or stop by the clock divide counter start flag. Figure 1.9.5 shows a block diagram of clock output.
Figure 1.9.6 shows a clock divided counter related register.
Clock source
selection
P57
f1
fC1
P57/CKOUT
1/2
f32
Clock divided counter (8)
Division n+1 n=0016 to FF16
Reload register (8)
Address 036E16
Low-order 8 bits
Data bus low-order bits
Example:
When f(XIN)=10MHz, count source = f32
n=0716 : approx. 19.5kHz
n=2616 : approx. 4.0kHz
n=4D16 : approx. 2.0kHz
n=9B16 : approx. 1.0kHz
Figure 1.9.5. Block diagram of clock output
Clock divided counter
b7
b0
Symbol
CDC
Address
036E16
Function
When reset
XX16
Values that can be set
8-bit timer
0016 to FF16
AA
A
A
AA
R W
Clock divided counter control register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
CDCC
Bit symbol
Address
036016
When reset
0XXXXXXX2
Bit name
Function
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
CDCS
Clock divided counter
start flg
Figure 1.9.6. Clock divided counter related register
24
0 : Stop
1 : Start
R W
AA
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Stop Mode, Wait Mode
Stop Mode
Writing “1” to the all-clock stop control bit (bit 0 at address 000716) stops all oscillation and the microcomputer enters stop mode. In stop mode, the content of the internal RAM is retained provided that VCC remains above 2V.
Because the oscillation , BCLK, f1 to f32, fC, fC132, fC1, fC32 and fAD stops in stop mode, peripheral functions
such as the A-D converter and watchdog timer do not function. However, timer A and timer B operate
provided that the event counter mode is set to an external pulse, and UART0 to UART2 functions provided
an external clock is selected. Table 1.9.2 shows the status of the ports in stop mode.
Stop mode is cancelled by a hardware reset or an interrupt. If an interrupt is to be used to cancel stop mode,
that interrupt must first have been enabled. If returning by an interrupt, that interrupt routine is executed.
When shifting from high-speed/medium-speed mode to stop mode and at a reset, the main clock division
select bit 0 (bit 6 at address 000616) is set to “1”. When shifting from low-speed/low power dissipation mode
to stop mode, the value before stop mode is retained.
Table 1.9.2. Port status during stop mode
Pin
Port
CKOUT
When fC1 selected
When f1, clock devided counter output selected
Status
Retains status before stop mode
“H”
Retains status before stop mode
Wait Mode
When a WAIT instruction is executed, the BCLK stops and the microcomputer enters the wait mode. In this
mode, oscillation continues but the BCLK and watchdog timer stop. Writing “1” to the WAIT peripheral
function clock stop bit and executing a WAIT instruction stops the clock being supplied to the internal
peripheral functions, allowing power dissipation to be reduced. Table 1.9.3 shows the status of the ports in
wait mode.
Wait mode is cancelled by a hardware reset or an interrupt. If an interrupt is used to cancel wait mode, the
microcomputer restarts from the interrupt routine using as BCLK, the clock that had been selected when the
WAIT instruction was executed.
Table 1.9.3. Port status during wait mode
Pin
Port
CKOUT
When fC1 selected
When f1, clock devided counter output selected
Status
Retains status before wait mode
Does not stop
Retains status before stop mode
Does not stop when the WAIT peripheral
function clock stop bit is “0”.
When the WAIT peripheral function clock
stop bit is “1”, the status immediately prior
to entering wait mode is main-tained.
25
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Status Transition of BCLK
Status Transition Of BCLK
Power dissipation can be reduced and low-voltage operation achieved by changing the count source for
BCLK. Table 1.9.4 shows the operating modes corresponding to the settings of system clock control
registers 0 and 1.
When reset, the device starts in division by 8 mode. The main clock division select bit 0(bit 6 at address
000616) changes to “1” when shifting from high-speed/medium-speed to stop mode and at a reset. When
shifting from low-speed/low power dissipation mode to stop mode, the value before stop mode is retained.
The following shows the operational modes of BCLK.
(1) Division by 2 mode
The main clock is divided by 2 to obtain the BCLK.
(2) Division by 4 mode
The main clock is divided by 4 to obtain the BCLK.
(3) Division by 8 mode
The main clock is divided by 8 to obtain the BCLK. When reset, the device starts operating from this
mode. Before the user can go from this mode to no division mode, division by 2 mode, or division by 4
mode, the main clock must be oscillating stably. When going to low-speed or lower power consumption
mode, make sure the sub-clock is oscillating stably.
(4) Division by 16 mode
The main clock is divided by 16 to obtain the BCLK.
(5) No-division mode
The main clock is divided by 1 to obtain the BCLK.
(6) Low-speed mode
fC is used as the BCLK. Note that oscillation of both the main and sub-clocks must have stabilized before
transferring from this mode to another or vice versa. At least 2 to 3 seconds are required after the subclock starts. Therefore, the program must be written to wait until this clock has stabilized immediately
after powering up and after stop mode is cancelled.
(7) Low power dissipation mode
fC is the BCLK and the main clock is stopped.
Note : Before the count source for BCLK can be changed from XIN to XCIN or vice versa, the clock to which
the count source is going to be switched must be oscillating stably. Allow a wait time in software for
the oscillation to stabilize before switching over the clock.
Table 1.9.4. Operating modes dictated by settings of system clock control registers 0 and 1
CM17
CM16
CM07
CM06
CM05
CM04
Operating mode of BCLK
0
1
Invalid
1
0
Invalid
Invalid
26
1
0
Invalid
1
0
Invalid
Invalid
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
Invalid
Invalid
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
Invalid
Invalid
Invalid
Invalid
Invalid
1
1
Division by 2 mode
Division by 4 mode
Division by 8 mode
Division by 16 mode
No-division mode
Low-speed mode
Low power dissipation mode
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Power control
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Power control
The following is a description of the three available power control modes:
Modes
Power control is available in three modes.
(a) Normal operation mode
• High-speed mode
Divide-by-1 frequency of the main clock becomes the BCLK. The CPU operates with the internal
clock selected. Each peripheral function operates according to its assigned clock.
• Medium-speed mode
Divide-by-2, divide-by-4, divide-by-8, or divide-by-16 frequency of the main clock becomes the
BCLK. The CPU operates according to the internal clock selected. Each peripheral function operates according to its assigned clock.
• Low-speed mode
fC becomes the BCLK. The CPU operates according to the fc clock. The fc clock is supplied by the
secondary clock. Each peripheral function operates according to its assigned clock.
• Low power consumption mode
The main clock operating in low-speed mode is stopped. The CPU operates according to the fC
clock. The fc clock is supplied by the secondary clock. The only peripheral functions that operate
are those with the sub-clock selected as the count source.
(b) Wait mode
The CPU operation is stopped. The oscillators do not stop.
(c) Stop mode
All oscillators stop. The CPU and all built-in peripheral functions stop. This mode, among the three
modes listed here, is the most effective in decreasing power consumption.
Figure 1.9.7 is the state transition diagram of the above modes.
27
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Power control
Transition of stop mode, wait mode
Reset
All oscillators stopped
Stop mode
CM10 = “1”
Interrupt
All oscillators stopped
Stop mode
Stop mode
Interrupt
CPU operation stopped
WAIT
instruction
High-speed/mediumspeed mode
Wait mode
Interrupt
All oscillators stopped
CM10 = “1”
Wait mode
Interrupt
Interrupt
CM10 = “1”
CPU operation stopped
WAIT
instruction
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-8 mode)
CPU operation stopped
WAIT
instruction
Low-speed/low power
dissipation mode
Wait mode
Interrupt
Normal mode
(Refer to the following for the transition of normal mode.)
Transition of normal mode
Main clock is oscillating
Sub clock is stopped
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-8 mode)
CM06 = “1”
BCLK : f(XIN)/8
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “1”
Main clock is oscillating CM04 = “0”
Sub clock is oscillating
CM07 = “0” (Note 1)
CM06 = “1”
CM04 = “0”
CM04 = “1”
(Notes 1, 3)
High-speed mode
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-2 mode)
BCLK : f(XIN)
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0”
CM17 = “0” CM16 = “0”
BCLK : f(XIN)/2
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0”
CM17 = “0” CM16 = “1”
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-8 mode)
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-16 mode)
BCLK : f(XIN)/8
CM07 = “0”
CM06 = “1”
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-4 mode)
BCLK : f(XIN)/4
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0”
CM17 = “1” CM16 = “0”
BCLK : f(XIN)/16
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0”
CM17 = “1” CM16 = “1”
Main clock is oscillating
Sub clock is oscillating
Low-speed mode
CM07 = “0”
(Note 1, 3)
BCLK : f(XCIN)
CM07 = “1”
CM07 = “1”
(Note 2)
CM05 = “0”
CM04 = “0”
CM06 = “0”
(Notes 1,3)
Main clock is oscillating
Sub clock is stopped
CM04 = “1”
High-speed mode
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-2 mode)
BCLK : f(XIN)
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0”
CM17 = “0” CM16 = “0”
BCLK : f(XIN)/2
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0”
CM17 = “0” CM16 = “1”
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-4 mode)
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-16 mode)
BCLK : f(XIN)/4
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0”
CM17 = “1” CM16 = “0”
BCLK : f(XIN)/16
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0”
CM17 = “1” CM16 = “1”
Main clock is stopped
Sub clock is oscillating
Low power dissipation mode
CM07 = “1” (Note 2)
CM05 = “1”
BCLK : f(XCIN)
CM07 = “1”
CM07 = “0” (Note 1)
CM06 = “0” (Note 3)
CM04 = “1”
Note 1: Switch clock after oscillation of main clock is sufficiently stable.
Note 2: Switch clock after oscillation of sub clock is sufficiently stable.
Note 3: Change CM06 after changing CM17 and CM16.
Note 4: Transit in accordance with arrow.
Figure 1.9.7. State transition diagram of Power control mode
28
CM05 = “1”
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Protection
Protection
The protection function is provided so that the values in important registers cannot be changed in the event
that the program runs out of control. Figure 1.9.8 shows the protect register. The values in the processor
mode register 0 (address 000416), processor mode register 1 (address 000516), system clock control register 0 (address 000616), system clock control register 1 (address 000716) can only be changed when the
respective bit in the protect register is set to “1”.
The system clock control registers 0 and 1 write-enable bit (bit 0 at 000A16) and processor mode register 0
and 1 write-enable bit (bit 1 at 000A16) do not automatically return to “0” after a value has been written to an
address. The program must therefore be written to return these bits to “0”.
Protect register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PRCR
Bit symbol
Address
000A16
Bit name
When reset
XXXXXX002
Function
PRC0
Enables writing to system clock
control registers 0 and 1 (addresses 0 : Write-inhibited
1 : Write-enabled
000616 and 000716)
PRC1
Enables writing to processor mode
0 : Write-inhibited
registers 0 and 1 (addresses 000416
1 : Write-enabled
and 000516)
A
A
A
A
AA
R W
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
Figure 1.9.8. Protect register
29
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
Overview of Interrupt
Type of Interrupts
Figure 1.10.1 lists the types of interrupts.










Hardware
Special
Peripheral I/O (Note)
















Interrupt
Software
Undefined instruction (UND instruction)
Overflow (INTO instruction)
BRK instruction
INT instruction
Reset
NMI
________
DBC
Watchdog timer
Single step
Address matched
_______
Note: Peripheral I/O interrupts are generated by the peripheral functions built into the microcomputer system.
Figure 1.10.1. Classification of interrupts
• Maskable interrupt :
An interrupt which can be enabled (disabled) by the interrupt enable flag
(I flag) or whose interrupt priority can be changed by priority level.
• Non-maskable interrupt : An interrupt which cannot be enabled (disabled) by the interrupt enable flag
(I flag) or whose interrupt priority cannot be changed by priority level.
30
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Interrupt
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Software Interrupts
A software interrupt occurs when executing certain instructions. Software interrupts are non-maskable
interrupts.
• Undefined instruction interrupt
An undefined instruction interrupt occurs when executing the UND instruction.
• Overflow interrupt
An overflow interrupt occurs when executing the INTO instruction with the overflow flag (O flag) set to
“1”. The following are instructions whose O flag changes by arithmetic:
ABS, ADC, ADCF, ADD, CMP, DIV, DIVU, DIVX, NEG, RMPA, SBB, SHA, SUB
• BRK interrupt
A BRK interrupt occurs when executing the BRK instruction.
• INT interrupt
An INT interrupt occurs when specifying one of software interrupt numbers 0 through 63 and executing the INT instruction. Software interrupt numbers 0 through 31 are assigned to peripheral I/O interrupts, so executing the INT instruction allows executing the same interrupt routine that a peripheral I/
O interrupt does.
The stack pointer (SP) used for the INT interrupt is dependent on which software interrupt number is
involved.
So far as software interrupt numbers 0 through 31 are concerned, the microcomputer saves the stack
pointer assignment flag (U flag) when it accepts an interrupt request. If change the U flag to “0” and
select the interrupt stack pointer (ISP), and then execute an interrupt sequence. When returning from
the interrupt routine, the U flag is returned to the state it was before the acceptance of interrupt request. So far as software numbers 32 through 63 are concerned, the stack pointer does not make a
shift.
31
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Interrupt
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Hardware Interrupts
Hardware interrupts are classified into two types — special interrupts and peripheral I/O interrupts.
(1) Special interrupts
Special interrupts are non-maskable interrupts.
• Reset
____________
Reset occurs if an “L” is input to the RESET pin.
_______
• NMI interrupt
_______
_______
An NMI interrupt occurs if an “L” is input to the NMI pin.
________
• DBC interrupt
This interrupt is exclusively for the debugger, do not use it in other circumstances.
• Watchdog timer interrupt
Generated by the watchdog timer.
• Single-step interrupt
This interrupt is exclusively for the debugger, do not use it in other circumstances. With the debug
flag (D flag) set to “1”, a single-step interrupt occurs after one instruction is executed.
• Address match interrupt
An address match interrupt occurs immediately before the instruction held in the address indicated by
the address match interrupt register is executed with the address match interrupt enable bit set to “1”.
If an address other than the first address of the instruction in the address match interrupt register is set,
no address match interrupt occurs.
(2) Peripheral I/O interrupts
A peripheral I/O interrupt is generated by one of built-in peripheral functions. Built-in peripheral functions are dependent on classes of products, so the interrupt factors too are dependent on classes of
products. The interrupt vector table is the same as the one for software interrupt numbers 0 through
31 the INT instruction uses. Peripheral I/O interrupts are maskable interrupts.
• Bus collision detection interrupt
This is an interrupt that the serial I/O bus collision detection generates.
• DMA0 interrupt, DMA1 interrupt
These are interrupts that DMA generates.
• Key-input interrupt
___
A key-input interrupt occurs if either a rising edge or a falling edge is input to the KI pin.
• A-D conversion interrupt
This is an interrupt that the A-D converter generates.
• UART0, UART1, UART2 transmission interrupt
These are interrupts that the serial I/O transmission generates.
• UART0, UART1, UART2 reception interrupt
These are interrupts that the serial I/O reception generates.
• Timer A0 interrupt through timer A7 interrupt
These are interrupts that timer A generates
• Timer B0 interrupt through timer B5 interrupt
These are interrupts that timer B generates.
________
________
• INT0 interrupt through INT5 interrupt
______
______
An INT interrupt occurs if either a rising edge or a falling edge is input to the INT pin.
32
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
Interrupts and Interrupt Vector Tables
If an interrupt request is accepted, a program branches to the interrupt routine set in the interrupt vector
table. Set the first address of the interrupt routine in each vector table. Figure 1.10.2 shows the format for
specifying the address.
Two types of interrupt vector tables are available — fixed vector table in which addresses are fixed and
variable vector table in which addresses can be varied by the setting.
AAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAA
MSB
LSB
Vector address + 0
Low address
Vector address + 1
Mid address
Vector address + 2
0000
High address
Vector address + 3
0000
0000
Figure 1.10.2. Format for specifying interrupt vector addresses
• Fixed vector tables
The fixed vector table is a table in which addresses are fixed. The vector tables are located in an area
extending from FFFDC16 to FFFFF16. One vector table comprises four bytes. Set the first address of
interrupt routine in each vector table. Table 1.10.1 shows the interrupts assigned to the fixed vector
tables and addresses of vector tables.
Table 1.10.1. Interrupts assigned to the fixed vector tables and addresses of vector tables
Interrupt source
Undefined instruction
Overflow
BRK instruction
Vector table addresses
Address (L) to address (H)
FFFDC16 to FFFDF16
FFFE016 to FFFE316
FFFE416 to FFFE716
Remarks
Interrupt on UND instruction
Interrupt on INTO instruction
If the vector contains FF16, program execution starts from
the address shown by the vector in the variable vector table
There is an address-matching interrupt enable bit
Do not use
Address match
FFFE816 to FFFEB16
Single step (Note)
FFFEC16 to FFFEF16
Watchdog timer
FFFF016 to FFFF316
________
DBC (Note)
FFFF416 to FFFF716
Do not use
_______
_______
NMI
FFFF816 to FFFFB16
External interrupt by input to NMI pin
Reset
FFFFC16 to FFFFF16
Note: Interrupts used for debugging purposes only.
33
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
• Variable vector tables
The addresses in the variable vector table can be modified, according to the user’s settings. Indicate
the first address using the interrupt table register (INTB). The 256-byte area subsequent to the address the INTB indicates becomes the area for the variable vector tables. One vector table comprises
four bytes. Set the first address of the interrupt routine in each vector table. Table 1.10.2 shows the
interrupts assigned to the variable vector tables and addresses of vector tables.
Table 1.10.2. Interrupts assigned to the variable vector tables and addresses of vector tables
Software interrupt number
Vector table address
Interrupt source
Address (L) to address (H)
Software interrupt number 0
+0 to +3 (Note 1)
BRK instruction
Software interrupt number 4
+16 to +19 (Note 1)
INT3
Software interrupt number 5
+20 to +23 (Note 1)
Timer B5
Software interrupt number 6
+24 to +27 (Note 1)
Timer B4
Software interrupt number 7
+28 to +31 (Note 1)
Timer B3
Software interrupt number 8
+32 to +35 (Note 1)
Timer A7
Software interrupt number 9
+36 to +39 (Note 1)
Timer A6
Software interrupt number 10
+40 to +43 (Note 1)
Timer A5/Bus collision detection
Remarks
Cannot be masked I flag
(Note 2)
Software interrupt number 11
+44 to +47 (Note 1)
DMA0
Software interrupt number 12
+48 to +51 (Note 1)
DMA1
Software interrupt number 13
+52 to +55 (Note 1)
Key input interrupt
Software interrupt number 14
+56 to +59 (Note 1)
A-D
Software interrupt number 15
+60 to +63 (Note 1)
UART2 transmit
Software interrupt number 16
+64 to +67 (Note 1)
UART2 receive
Software interrupt number 17
+68 to +71 (Note 1)
UART0 transmit
Software interrupt number 18
+72 to +75 (Note 1)
UART0 receive
Software interrupt number 19
+76 to +79 (Note 1)
UART1 transmit
Software interrupt number 20
+80 to +83 (Note 1)
UART1 receive
Software interrupt number 21
+84 to +87 (Note 1)
Timer A0
Software interrupt number 22
+88 to +91 (Note 1)
Timer A1
Software interrupt number 23
+92 to +95 (Note 1)
Timer A2
Software interrupt number 24
+96 to +99 (Note 1)
Timer A3/INT4 (Note 3)
Software interrupt number 25
+100 to +103 (Note 1)
Timer A4/INT5 (Note 3)
Software interrupt number 26
+104 to +107 (Note 1)
Timer B0
Software interrupt number 27
+108 to +111 (Note 1)
Timer B1
Software interrupt number 28
+112 to +115 (Note 1)
Timer B2
Software interrupt number 29
+116 to +119 (Note 1)
INT0
Software interrupt number 30
+120 to +123 (Note 1)
INT1
Software interrupt number 31
+124 to +127 (Note 1)
INT2
Software interrupt number 32
+128 to +131 (Note 1)
to
Software interrupt number 63
to
+252 to +255 (Note 1)
Software interrupt
Cannot be masked I flag
Note 1: Address relative to address in interrupt table register (INTB).
Note 2: It is selected by interrupt request cause select bit (bit 4 in address 035E16 ).
Note 3: It is selected by interrupt request cause select bit (bit 6, 7 in address 035F16 ).
34
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
Interrupt Control
Descriptions are given here regarding how to enable or disable maskable interrupts and how to set the
priority to be accepted. What is described here does not apply to non-maskable interrupts.
Enable or disable a maskable interrupt using the interrupt enable flag (I flag), interrupt priority level selection bit, or processor interrupt priority level (IPL). Whether an interrupt request is present or absent is
indicated by the interrupt request bit. The interrupt request bit and the interrupt priority level selection bit
are located in the interrupt control register of each interrupt. Also, the interrupt enable flag (I flag) and the
IPL are located in the flag register (FLG).
Figure 1.10.3 shows the memory map of the interrupt control registers.
Interrupt control register (Note2)
AAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TBiIC(i=3 to 5)
TAiIC(i=6, 7)
TA5IC/BCNIC
DMiIC(i=0, 1)
KUPIC
ADIC
SiTIC(i=0 to 2)
SiRIC(i=0 to 2)
TAiIC(i=0 to 2)
TBiIC(i=0 to 2)
Bit symbol
ILVL0
Address
004516 to 004716
004816, 004916
004A16
004B16, 004C16
004D16
004E16
005116, 005316, 004F16
005216, 005416, 005016
005516 to 005716
005A16 to 005C16
Bit name
Interrupt priority level
select bit
ILVL2
IR
Function
b2 b1 b0
000:
001:
010:
011:
100:
101:
110:
111:
ILVL1
Interrupt request bit
When reset
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
Level 0 (interrupt disabled)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Level 4
Level 5
Level 6
Level 7
0 : Interrupt not requested
1 : Interrupt requested
Nothing is assigned.
AA
AAAA
AA
AA
R
W
(Note 1)
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns
out to be indeterminate.
Note 1: This bit can only be accessed for reset (= 0), but cannot be accessed for set (= 1).
Note 2: To rewrite the interrupt control register, do so at a point that dose not generate the
interrupt request for that register. For details, see the precautions for interrupts.
AAA
A
AA
b7
b6
b5
0
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
INTiIC(i=0 to 2)
005D16 to 005F16
(i=3)
004416
TAiIC/INTjIC(i=3, 4)
005816, 005916
(j=4, 5)
005816, 005916
Bit symbol
ILVL0
Bit name
Interrupt priority level
select bit
ILVL1
ILVL2
IR
POL
When reset
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
Function
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 : Level 0 (interrupt disabled)
0 0 1 : Level 1
0 1 0 : Level 2
0 1 1 : Level 3
1 0 0 : Level 4
1 0 1 : Level 5
1 1 0 : Level 6
1 1 1 : Level 7
Interrupt request bit
0: Interrupt not requested
1: Interrupt requested
Polarity select bit
0 : Selects falling edge
1 : Selects rising edge
Reserved bit
Always set to “0”
Nothing is assigned.
R
W
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
(Note 1)
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns
out to be indeterminate.
Note 1: This bit can only be accessed for reset (= 0), but cannot be accessed for set (= 1).
Note 2: To rewrite the interrupt control register, do so at a point that dose not generate the
interrupt request for that register. For details, see the precautions for interrupts.
Figure 1.10.3. Interrupt control registers
35
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Interrupt
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt Enable Flag (I flag)
The interrupt enable flag (I flag) controls the enabling and disabling of maskable interrupts. Setting this
flag to “1” enables all maskable interrupts; setting it to “0” disables all maskable interrupts. This flag is set
to “0” after reset.
Interrupt Request Bit
The interrupt request bit is set to "1" by hardware when an interrupt is requested. After the interrupt is
accepted and jumps to the corresponding interrupt vector, the request bit is set to "0" by hardware. The
interrupt request bit can also be set to "0" by software. (Do not set this bit to "1").
36
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
Interrupt Priority Level Select Bit and Processor Interrupt Priority Level (IPL)
Set the interrupt priority level using the interrupt priority level select bit, which is one of the component bits
of the interrupt control register. When an interrupt request occurs, the interrupt priority level is compared
with the IPL. The interrupt is enabled only when the priority level of the interrupt is higher than the IPL.
Therefore, setting the interrupt priority level to “0” disables the interrupt.
Table 1.10.3 shows the settings of interrupt priority levels and Table 1.10.4 shows the interrupt levels
enabled, according to the consist of the IPL.
The following are conditions under which an interrupt is accepted:
· interrupt enable flag (I flag) = 1
· interrupt request bit = 1
· interrupt priority level > IPL
The interrupt enable flag (I flag), the interrupt request bit, the interrupt priority select bit, and the IPL are
independent, and they are not affected by one another.
Table 1.10.3. Settings of interrupt priority
levels
Interrupt priority
level select bit
Interrupt priority
level
Table 1.10.4. Interrupt levels enabled according
to the contents of the IPL
Priority
order
b2 b1 b0
IPL
Enabled interrupt priority levels
IPL2 IPL1 IPL0
0
0
0
Level 0 (interrupt disabled)
0
0
0
Interrupt levels 1 and above are enabled
0
0
1
Level 1
0
0
1
Interrupt levels 2 and above are enabled
0
1
0
Level 2
0
1
0
Interrupt levels 3 and above are enabled
0
1
1
Level 3
0
1
1
Interrupt levels 4 and above are enabled
1
0
0
Level 4
1
0
0
Interrupt levels 5 and above are enabled
1
0
1
Level 5
1
0
1
Interrupt levels 6 and above are enabled
1
1
0
Level 6
1
1
0
Interrupt levels 7 and above are enabled
1
1
1
Level 7
1
1
1
All maskable interrupts are disabled
Low
High
37
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
Rewrite the interrupt control register
To rewrite the interrupt control register, do so at a point that does not generate the interrupt request for
that register. If there is possibility of the interrupt request occur, rewrite the interrupt control register after
the interrupt is disabled. The program examples are described as follow:
Example 1:
INT_SWITCH1:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
NOP
NOP
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Four NOP instructions are required when using HOLD function.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 2:
INT_SWITCH2:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
MOV.W MEM, R0
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Dummy read.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 3:
INT_SWITCH3:
PUSHC FLG
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
POPC FLG
; Push Flag register onto stack
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Enable interrupts.
The reason why two NOP instructions (four when using the HOLD function) or dummy read are inserted
before FSET I in Examples 1 and 2 is to prevent the interrupt enable flag I from being set before the
interrupt control register is rewritten due to effects of the instruction queue.
When a instruction to rewrite the interrupt control register is executed but the interrupt is disabled, the
interrupt request bit is not set sometimes even if the interrupt request for that register has been generated. This will depend on the instruction. If this creates problems, use the below instructions to change
the register.
Instructions : AND, OR, BCLR, BSET
38
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
Interrupt Sequence
An interrupt sequence — what are performed over a period from the instant an interrupt is accepted to the
instant the interrupt routine is executed — is described here.
If an interrupt occurs during execution of an instruction, the processor determines its priority when the
execution of the instruction is completed, and transfers control to the interrupt sequence from the next
cycle. If an interrupt occurs during execution of either the SMOVB, SMOVF, SSTR or RMPA instruction,
the processor temporarily suspends the instruction being executed, and transfers control to the interrupt
sequence.
In the interrupt sequence, the processor carries out the following in sequence given:
(1) CPU gets the interrupt information (the interrupt number and interrupt request level) by reading address 0000016. After this, the corresponding interrupt request bit becomes “0”.
(2) Saves the content of the flag register (FLG) as it was immediately before the start of interrupt sequence
in the temporary register (Note) within the CPU.
(3) Sets the interrupt enable flag (I flag), the debug flag (D flag), and the stack pointer select flag (U flag) to
“0” (the U flag, however does not change if the INT instruction, in software interrupt numbers 32
through 63, is executed)
(4) Saves the content of the temporary register (Note) within the CPU in the stack area.
(5) Saves the content of the program counter (PC) in the stack area.
(6) Sets the interrupt priority level of the accepted instruction in the IPL.
After the interrupt sequence is completed, the processor resumes executing instructions from the first
address of the interrupt routine.
Note: This register cannot be utilized by the user.
Interrupt Response Time
'Interrupt response time' is the period between the instant an interrupt occurs and the instant the first
instruction within the interrupt routine has been executed. This time comprises the period from the
occurrence of an interrupt to the completion of the instruction under execution at that moment (a) and the
time required for executing the interrupt sequence (b). Figure 1.10.4 shows the interrupt response time.
Interrupt request generated
Interrupt request acknowledged
Time
Instruction
Interrupt sequence
(a)
Instruction in
interrupt routine
(b)
Interrupt response time
(a) Time from interrupt request is generated to when the instruction then under execution is completed.
(b) Time in which the instruction sequence is executed.
Figure 1.10.4. Interrupt response time
39
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
Time (a) is dependent on the instruction under execution. Thirty cycles is the maximum required for the
DIVX instruction (without wait).
Time (b) is as shown in Table 1.10.5.
Table 1.10.5. Time required for executing the interrupt sequence
Interrupt vector address
Stack pointer (SP) value
16-Bit bus, without wait
8-Bit bus, without wait
Even
Even
18 cycles (Note 1)
20 cycles (Note 1)
Even
Odd
19 cycles (Note 1)
20 cycles (Note 1)
Odd (Note 2)
Even
19 cycles (Note 1)
20 cycles (Note 1)
Odd (Note 2)
Odd
20 cycles (Note 1)
20 cycles (Note 1)
________
Note 1: Add 2 cycles in the case of a DBC interrupt; add 1 cycle in the case either of an address coincidence
interrupt or of a single-step interrupt.
Note 2: Locate an interrupt vector address in an even address, if possible.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
BCLK
Internal
address bus
Internal
data bus
Address
0000
Interrupt
information
Internal
read signal
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
SP-2
SP-2
contents
SP-4
SP-4
contents
vec
vec+2
vec
contents
PC
vec+2
contents
Indeterminate
Internal
write signal
The indeterminate segment is dependent on the queue buffer.
If the queue buffer is ready to take an instruction, a read cycle occurs.
Figure 1.10.5. Time required for executing the interrupt sequence
Variation of IPL when Interrupt Request is Accepted
If an interrupt request is accepted, the interrupt priority level of the accepted interrupt is set in the IPL.
If an interrupt request, that does not have an interrupt priority level, is accepted, one of the values shown
in Table 1.10.6 is set in the IPL.
Table 1.10.6. Relationship between interrupts without interrupt priority levels and IPL
Interrupt sources without priority levels
Value set in the IPL
_______
Watchdog timer, NMI
7
Reset
0
Other
40
Not changed
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
Saving Registers
In the interrupt sequence, only the contents of the flag register (FLG) and that of the program counter
(PC) are saved in the stack area.
First, the processor saves the four higher-order bits of the program counter, and 4 upper-order bits and 8
lower-order bits of the FLG register, 16 bits in total, in the stack area, then saves 16 lower-order bits of the
program counter. Figure 1.10.6 shows the state of the stack as it was before the acceptance of the
interrupt request, and the state the stack after the acceptance of the interrupt request.
Save other necessary registers at the beginning of the interrupt routine using software. Using the
PUSHM instruction alone can save all the registers except the stack pointer (SP).
Address
MSB
Stack area
Address
MSB
LSB
Stack area
LSB
m–4
m–4
Program counter (PCL)
m–3
m–3
Program counter (PCM)
m–2
m–2
Flag register (FLGL)
m–1
m–1
m
Content of previous stack
m+1
Content of previous stack
Stack status before interrupt request
is acknowledged
[SP]
Stack pointer
value before
interrupt occurs
Flag register
(FLGH)
[SP]
New stack
pointer value
Program
counter (PCH)
m
Content of previous stack
m+1
Content of previous stack
Stack status after interrupt request
is acknowledged
Figure 1.10.6. State of stack before and after acceptance of interrupt request
41
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
The operation of saving registers carried out in the interrupt sequence is dependent on whether the
content of the stack pointer, at the time of acceptance of an interrupt request, is even or odd. If the
content of the stack pointer (Note) is even, the content of the flag register (FLG) and the content of the
program counter (PC) are saved, 16 bits at a time. If odd, their contents are saved in two steps, 8 bits at
a time. Figure 1.10.7 shows the operation of the saving registers.
Note: Stack pointer indicated by U flag.
(1) Stack pointer (SP) contains even number
Address
Stack area
Sequence in which order
registers are saved
[SP] – 5 (Odd)
[SP] – 4 (Even)
Program counter (PCL)
[SP] – 3(Odd)
Program counter (PCM)
[SP] – 2 (Even)
Flag register (FLGL)
[SP] – 1(Odd)
[SP]
Flag register
(FLGH)
Program
counter (PCH)
(2) Saved simultaneously,
all 16 bits
(1) Saved simultaneously,
all 16 bits
(Even)
Finished saving registers
in two operations.
(2) Stack pointer (SP) contains odd number
Address
Stack area
Sequence in which order
registers are saved
[SP] – 5 (Even)
[SP] – 4(Odd)
Program counter (PCL)
(3)
[SP] – 3 (Even)
Program counter (PCM)
(4)
[SP] – 2(Odd)
Flag register (FLGL)
[SP] – 1 (Even)
[SP]
Flag register
(FLGH)
Program
counter (PCH)
Saved simultaneously,
all 8 bits
(1)
(2)
(Odd)
Finished saving registers
in four operations.
Note: [SP] denotes the initial value of the stack pointer (SP) when interrupt request is acknowledged.
After registers are saved, the SP content is [SP] minus 4.
Figure 1.10.7. Operation of saving registers
42
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
Returning from an Interrupt Routine
Executing the REIT instruction at the end of an interrupt routine returns the contents of the flag register
(FLG) as it was immediately before the start of interrupt sequence and the contents of the program counter
(PC), both of which have been saved in the stack area. Then control returns to the program that was being
executed before the acceptance of the interrupt request, so that the suspended process resumes.
Return the other registers saved by software within the interrupt routine using the POPM or similar instruction before executing the REIT instruction.
Interrupt Priority
If there are two or more interrupt requests occurring at a point in time within a single sampling (checking
whether interrupt requests are made), the interrupt assigned a higher priority is accepted.
Assign an arbitrary priority to maskable interrupts (peripheral I/O interrupts) using the interrupt priority level
select bit. If the same interrupt priority level is assigned, however, the interrupt assigned a higher hardware
priority is accepted.
Priorities of the special interrupts, such as Reset (dealt with as an interrupt assigned the highest priority),
watchdog timer interrupt, etc. are regulated by hardware.
Figure 1.10.8 shows the priorities of hardware interrupts.
Software interrupts are not affected by the interrupt priority. If an instruction is executed, control branches
invariably to the interrupt routine.
_______
________
Reset > NMI > DBC > Watchdog timer > Peripheral I/O > Single step > Address match
Figure 1.10.8. Hardware interrupts priorities
Interrupt resolution circuit
When two or more interrupts are generated simultaneously, this circuit selects the interrupt with the highest
priority level. Figure 1.10.9 shows the circuit that judges the interrupt priority level.
43
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
Priority level of each interrupt
INT1
Level 0 (initial value)
High
Timer B2
Timer B0
Timer A3/INT4
Timer A1
Timer B4
INT3
INT2
INT0
Timer B1
Timer A4/INT5
Timer A2
Timer B3
Timer B5
UART1 reception
UART0 reception
Priority of peripheral I/O interrupts
(if priority levels are same)
UART2 reception
A-D conversion
DMA1
Timer A5/Bus collision detection
Timer A7
Timer A0
UART1 transmission
UART0 transmission
UART2 transmission
Key input interrupt
DMA0
Timer A6
Processor interrupt priority level (IPL)
Low
Interrupt request level judgment output
Interrupt enable flag (I flag)
Interrupt request accepted
Address match
Watchdog timer
DBC
NMI
Reset
Figure 1.10.9. Maskable interrupts priorities (peripheral I/O interrupts)
44
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
______
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
INT Interrupt
______
INT Interrupt
________
________
INT0 to INT5 are triggered by the edges of external inputs. The edge polarity is selected using the polarity select bit.
________
Of interrupt control registers, 005816 is used both as timer A3 and external interrupt INT4 input control register, and
________
005916 is used both as timer A4 and as external interrupt INT5 input control register. Use the interrupt request cause
select bits - bits 6 and 7 of the interrupt request cause select register 1 (address 035F16) - to specify which interrupt
________
request cause to select. When INT4 is selected as an interrupt source, the input port for it can be selected by bits 0 and
________
1 of the interrupt source select register 0 (address 035E16). Similarly, when INT5 is selected as an interrupt source, the
input port for it can be selected by bits 2 and 3 of the interrupt source select register 0 (address 035E16). After having
set an interrupt request cause and interrupt input ports, be sure to set the corresponding interrupt request bit to “0”
before enabling an interrupt.
Either of the interrupt control registers - 005816, 005916 - has the polarity-switching bit. Be sure to set this bit to “0” to
select an timer as the interrupt request cause.
As for external interrupt input, an interrupt can be generated both at the rising edge and at the falling edge by setting
_______
“1” in the INTi interrupt polarity switching bit of the interrupt request cause select register 1 (035F16). To select two
edges, set the polarity switching bit of the corresponding interrupt control register to ‘falling edge’ (“0”).
When INT4 input pin select bits = “11”, INT4 interrupt polarity switching bit = “0”, and polarity select bit = “1” of the INT4
interrupt control register, an interrupt is generated by a rising edge on the input port when the exclusive pin is “H”, as
shown by “Single edge, Rise” in Figure 1.10.12. When the exclusive pin is “H”, interrupts can only be generated by an
________
active transition on a single edge. The same applies to INT5.
Figure 1.10.10 shows the interrupt request cause select register.
AA
A
A
AA
AAA
AA
A
Interrupt request cause select register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
IFSR0
0 0
Bit
symbol
IFSR00
Address
035E16
When reset
X00000002
Bit name
Function
00: No INT4 input
01: P46 input enabled
10: P47 input enabled
11: P46, P47 input enabled
INT5 input pin select bit
00: No INT5 input
01: P80 input enabled
10: P81 input enabled
11: P80, P81 input enabled
Interrupt request cause
select bitt
0 : Timer A5
1 : Bus collision detection
IFSR01
IFSR02
IFSR03
IFSR04
Reserved bit
Must always be set to “0”
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out
to be indeterminate.
AA
A
A
AA
AAA
AA
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
R W
INT4 input pin select bit
Interrupt request cause select register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
IFSR1
Bit
symbol
Address
035F16
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
IFSR10
INT0 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR11
INT1 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR12
INT2 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR13
INT3 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR14
INT4 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR15
INT5 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR16
Interrupt request cause
select bit
0 : Timer A3
1 : INT4
IFSR17
Interrupt request cause
select bit
0 : Timer A4
1 : INT5
Figure 1.10.10. Interrupt request cause select registers 0, 1
AAAA
AAAA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AAA
R W
45
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
______
_______
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
INT Interrupt, NMI Interrupt
Interrupt edge
select bit
TAiOUT/INTi+1
i=3, 4
TAiIN/INTi+1
Two edge detect
INTi+1
input pin
select bit
Interrupt
request
Two edge detect
________
________
Figure 1.10.11. Constitution of INT4 and INT5
Polarity select bit (bit4 of interrupt control register)
1: Rising edge
0: Falling edge
0: One edge
"H"
"L"
"L"
"H"
"H"
"L"
"L"
"H"
1: Two edges
INT4, INT5 interrupt polarity switching bit
(Bits 4, 5 of interrupt request cause select register 1)
"H"
"L"
"H"
"L"
________
________
Figure 1.10.12. Typical timings in two input interrupt of INT4 and INT5 selected
______
NMI Interrupt
______
______
______
An NMI interrupt is generated when the input to the P77/NMI pin changes from “H” to “L”. The NMI interrupt
is a non-maskable external interrupt. The pin level can be checked in the port P77 register (bit 7 at address
03ED16).
This pin cannot be used as a normal port input.
46
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Key Input Interrupt
Key Input Interrupt
A key input interrupt request is generated when an active edge selected by the key input mode register’s
P1, P2 input edge select bits occurs on one of input ports P10 to P17, P20 to P27, or P30 to P33 whose
direction register is set for input and which has been enabled for key input by the key input enable bit. For
P30 to P33, key input interrupt requests are always generated by a falling edge.
A key input interrupt can also be used as a key-on wakeup function for cancelling the wait mode or stop
mode. When using an oscillator connected between XCIN—XCOUT and the corresponding port has been set
to have a pullup, if the P1, P2 key input select bits (bits 0, 2 at address 012616) are set for “Two edges” and
the P1, P2 key input enable bits (bits 1, 3 at address 012616) are “Enabled”, pullups on P10 to P17 and P20
to P27 are automatically turned on and the port is pulled “H” for only a period of about 244 us (Note) at
intervals of approximately 7.8 ms (Note), as shown in Figure 1.10.15. For settings by a program, set up the
P1, P2 key input select bits and pullup control register 0 (address 03FC16) and then set the P1, P2 key input
enable bit to “1”.
Figure 1.10.13 shows a block diagram for key input interrupts. Note that when a “L” signal is applied to any
pin which has had its key input enable bit set to 0 and is not processed for input inhibition, input to other pins
are not detected as an interrupt. The fC32 is affected by a clock prescaler reset flag.
Note : XCIN = 32.768kHZ
Port P10 direction register
Port P100-P103 pull-up select bit
P1 key input select bit
P1 key input enable bit
Pull-up
transistor
One-shot
generating circuit
1/8
fC32
Port P1, P2 pull-up select bit
P1 key input select bit • P1 key input enable bit
CK Q
"1"
Two edge detect
"1"
P1 key input enable bit
D
"0"
"0"
P10/KI0
Pull-up
transistor
Port P10 direction register
CK Q
D
"1"
Two edge detect
"1"
"0"
"0"
Key input interrupt control register
P17/KI7
(Address 004D16)
P2 key input enable bit
Pull-up
transistor
Port P17 direction register
CK Q
D
"1"
Two edge detect
"1"
"0"
Interrupt control circuit
Key input interrupt
request
"0"
P20/KI8
Pull-up
transistor
Port P20 direction register
CK Q
D
"1"
"1"
Two edge detect
"0"
"0"
P27/KI15
Port P27 direction register
Port P30 direction registe
Pull-up
transistor
P3 key input enable bit
Port P3 pull-up select bit
Port P30 direction register
P30/KI16
Pull-up
transistor
Port P33 direction register
P33/KI19
Figure 1.10.13. Block diagram of key input interrupt
47
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Key Input Interrupt
AA
A
A
AA
AAA
AA
A
Key input mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
KUPM
Bit
symbol
Address
012616
When reset
011000002
Bit name
R
Function
P1KIS
P1 key input select bit (Note1)
0 : Falling edge
1 : Two edges
P1KIE
P1 key input enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
P2KIS
P2 key input select bit (Note1)
0 : Falling edge
1 : Two edges
P2KIE
P2 key input enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
P3KIE
P3 key input enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
PUP12L
P120 to P123 pull-up (Note2)
PUP12H
P124 to P127 pull-up (Note2)
The corresponding port is
pulled high with a pull-up
resistor
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high
PUP13
P130 to P132 pull-up (Note2)
W
AA
A
A
AA
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
AA
Note 1 : If this bit is set for “Two edges” when the corresponding port has been
specified to have a pullup, the port is automatically pulled high intermittently.
Operating sub-clock.
Note 2 : The pull-up resistance is not connected for pins that are set for output from
peripheral functions, regardless of the setting in the pull-up control register.
Figure 1.10.14. Key input mode register
Intermittent pull-up operation starts
Direction register
Output
Key input select bit
Pull-up control
Key input enable bit
Input
Falling edge
Two edges
Not pulled high
Pulled high
Disable
Enable
Approx. 7.8ms
(Note 1)
Approx. 7.8ms
(Note 1)
Pull-up
(“H” : Pulled high
“L” : Not pulled high)
Approx. 244µs
(Note 1)(Note 2)
Key input value latch
Approx. 244µs
(Note 1)
Key input value latch
Note 1 : XCIN = 32.768kHz
Note 2 : There may be the thing that interrupt request bit is set to “1” when input LOW in the first key input value latch timing.
Figure 1.10.15. Intermittent pull-up operation
48
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Address Match Interrupt
Address Match Interrupt
An address match interrupt is generated when the address match interrupt address register contents match
the program counter value. Two address match interrupts can be set, each of which can be enabled and
disabled by an address match interrupt enable bit. Address match interrupts are not affected by the interrupt enable flag (I flag) and processor interrupt priority level (IPL). The value of the program counter (PC)
for an address match interrupt varies depending on the instruction being executed.
Figure 1.10.16 shows the address match interrupt-related registers.
Address match interrupt enable register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
AIER
Address
000916
When reset
XXXXXX002
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
Bit symbol
Bit name
Function
AIER0
Address match interrupt 0
enable bit
0 : Interrupt disabled
1 : Interrupt enabled
AIER1
Address match interrupt 1
enable bit
0 : Interrupt disabled
1 : Interrupt enabled
RW
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to
be indeterminated.
Address match interrupt register i (i = 0, 1)
(b23)
b7
(b19)
b3
(b16)(b15)
b0 b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
RMAD0
RMAD1
Address
001216 to 001016
001616 to 001416
Function
Address setting register for address match interrupt
When reset
X0000016
X0000016
AA
Values that can be set R W
0000016 to FFFFF16
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to
be indeterminated.
Figure 1.10.16. Address match interrupt-related registers
49
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Precautions for Interrupts
Precautions for Interrupts
(1) Reading address 0000016
• When maskable interrupt is occurred, CPU read the interrupt information (the interrupt number and
interrupt request level) in the interrupt sequence.
The interrupt request bit of the certain interrupt written in address 0000016 will then be set to “0”.
Reading address 0000016 by software sets enabled highest priority interrupt source request bit to “0”.
Though the interrupt is generated, the interrupt routine may not be executed.
Do not read address 0000016 by software.
(2) Setting the stack pointer
• The value of the stack pointer immediately after reset is initialized to 000016. Accepting an interrupt
before setting a value in the stack pointer may become a factor of runaway. Be sure to set a value in
_______
the stack pointer before accepting an interrupt. When using the NMI interrupt, initialize the stack point
at the beginning of a program. Concerning the first instruction immediately after reset, generating any
_______
interrupts including the NMI interrupt is prohibited.
_______
(3) The NMI interrupt
_______
_______
•The NMI interrupt can not be disabled. Be sure to connect NMI pin to Vcc via a pull-up resistor if
unused.
_______
• The NMI pin also serves as P77, which is exclusively input. Reading the contents of the P7 register
allows reading the pin value. Use the reading of this pin only for establishing the pin level at the time
_______
when the NMI interrupt is input.
_______
• Do not reset the CPU with the input to the NMI pin being in the “L” state.
_______
• Do not attempt to go into stop mode with the input to the NMI pin being in the “L” state. With the input to
_______
the NMI being in the “L” state, the CM10 is fixed to “0”, so attempting to go into stop mode is turned
down.
_______
• Do not attempt to go into wait mode with the input to the NMI pin being in the “L” state. With the input to
_______
the NMI pin being in the “L” state, the CPU stops but the oscillation does not stop, so no power is saved.
In this instance, the CPU is returned to the normal state by a later interrupt.
_______
• Signals input to the NMI pin require an “L” level of 1 clock or more, from the operation clock of the CPU.
(4) External interrupt
________
• Either an “L” level or an “H” level of at least 250 ns width is necessary for the signal input to pins INT0
________
through INT5 regardless of the CPU operation clock.
________
________
• When the polarity of the INT0 to INT5 pins is changed, the interrupt request bit is sometimes set to "1".
After changing the polarity, set the interrupt request bit to "0". Figure 1.10.17 shows the procedure for
______
changing the INT interrupt generate factor.
50
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Precautions for Interrupts
Clear the interrupt enable flag to “0”
(Disable interrupt)
Set the interrupt priority level to level 0
(Disable INTi interrupt)
Set the polarity select bit
Clear the interrupt request bit to “0”
Set the interrupt priority level to level 1 to 7
(Enable the accepting of INTi interrupt request)
Set the interrupt enable flag to “1”
(Enable interrupt)
______
Figure 1.10.17. Switching condition of INT interrupt request
51
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Precautions for Interrupts
(5) Rewrite the interrupt control register
• To rewrite the interrupt control register, do so at a point that does not generate the interrupt request for
that register. If there is possibility of the interrupt request occur, rewrite the interrupt control register after
the interrupt is disabled. The program examples are described as follow:
Example 1:
INT_SWITCH1:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
NOP
NOP
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Four NOP instructions are required when using HOLD function.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 2:
INT_SWITCH2:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
MOV.W MEM, R0
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Dummy read.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 3:
INT_SWITCH3:
PUSHC FLG
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
POPC FLG
; Push Flag register onto stack
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Enable interrupts.
The reason why two NOP instructions (four when using the HOLD function) or dummy read are inserted
before FSET I in Examples 1 and 2 is to prevent the interrupt enable flag I from being set before the
interrupt control register is rewritten due to effects of the instruction queue.
• When a instruction to rewrite the interrupt control register is executed but the interrupt is disabled, the
interrupt request bit is not set sometimes even if the interrupt request for that register has been generated. This will depend on the instruction. If this creates problems, use the below instructions to change
the register.
Instructions : AND, OR, BCLR, BSET
52
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Watchdog Timer
Watchdog Timer
The watchdog timer has the function of detecting when the program is out of control. The watchdog timer is
a 15-bit counter which down-counts the clock derived by dividing the BCLK using the prescaler. A watchdog
timer interrupt is generated when an underflow occurs in the watchdog timer. When XIN is selected for the
BCLK, bit 7 of the watchdog timer control register (address 000F16) selects the prescaler division ratio (by
16 or by 128). When XCIN is selected as the BCLK, the prescaler is set for division by 2 regardless of bit 7
of the watchdog timer control register (address 000F16). Thus the watchdog timer's period can be calculated as given below. The watchdog timer's period is, however, subject to an error due to the prescaler.
With XIN chosen for BCLK
Watchdog timer period =
prescaler dividing ratio (16 or 128) X watchdog timer count (32768)
BCLK
With XCIN chosen for BCLK
Watchdog timer period =
prescaler dividing ratio (2) X watchdog timer count (32768)
BCLK
For example, suppose that BCLK runs at 10 MHz and that 16 has been chosen for the dividing ratio of the
prescaler, then the watchdog timer's period becomes approximately 52.4 ms.
The watchdog timer is initialized by writing to the watchdog timer start register (address 000E16) and when
a watchdog timer interrupt request is generated. The prescaler is initialized only when the microcomputer is
reset. After a reset is cancelled, the watchdog timer and prescaler are both stopped. The count is started by
writing to the watchdog timer start register (address 000E16).
Figure 1.11.1 shows the block diagram of the watchdog timer. Figure 1.11.2 shows the watchdog timerrelated registers.
Prescaler
1/16
BCLK
1/128
“CM07 = 0”
“WDC7 = 0”
“CM07 = 0”
“WDC7 = 1”
Watchdog timer
Watchdog timer
interrupt request
“CM07 = 1”
1/2
Write to the watchdog timer
start register
(address 000E16)
Set to
“7FFF16”
RESET
Figure 1.15.1. Block diagram of watchdog timer
53
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Watchdog Timer
Watchdog timer control register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0
Symbol
WDC
Bit symbol
Address
000F16
When reset
000XXXXX2
Bit name
Function
High-order bit of watchdog timer
Reserved bit
Must always be set to “0”
Reserved bit
Must always be set to “0”
WDC7
Prescaler select bit
0 : Divided by 16
1 : Divided by 128
AA
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
R W
Watchdog timer start register
b7
b0
Symbol
WDTS
Address
000E16
When reset
Indeterminate
Function
The watchdog timer is initialized and starts counting after a write instruction to
this register. The watchdog timer value is always initialized to “7FFF16”
regardless of whatever value is written.
Figure 1.11.2. Watchdog timer control and start registers
54
A
R W
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
DMAC
DMAC
This microcomputer has two DMAC (direct memory access controller) channels that allow data to be sent to
memory without using the CPU. DMAC shares the same data bus with the CPU. The DMAC is given a
higher right of using the bus than the CPU, which leads to working the cycle stealing method. On this
account, the operation from the occurrence of DMA transfer request signal to the completion of 1-word (16bit) or 1-byte (8-bit) data transfer can be performed at high speed. Figure 1.12.1 shows the block diagram
of the DMAC. Table 1.12.1 shows the DMAC specifications. Figures 1.12.2 to 1.12.4 show the registers
used by the DMAC.
AA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AAAAAAA
AA
A
AAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAA
AA
A
AAA A
AA
A
AAA
A
AA
AAA A AA
AA
AA
AA
A
A
AA
A
AA
AA
A
A
AAAAA
A
AA
AAA A AA
AA
AA
A
A
A
AA
AA
AA
A
A
A
AA
A
A AA
AA
AA
AA
Address bus
DMA0 source pointer SAR0(20)
(addresses 002216 to 002016)
DMA0 destination pointer DAR0 (20)
(addresses 002616 to 002416)
DMA0 forward address pointer (20) (Note)
DMA0 transfer counter reload register TCR0 (16)
(addresses 002916, 002816)
DMA0 transfer counter TCR0 (16)
DMA1 source pointer SAR1 (20)
(addresses 003216 to 003016)
DMA1 destination pointer DAR1 (20)
(addresses 003616 to 003416)
DMA1 transfer counter reload register TCR1 (16)
DMA1 forward address pointer (20) (Note)
(addresses 003916, 003816)
DMA1 transfer counter TCR1 (16)
DMA latch high-order bits
DMA latch low-order bits
Data bus low-order bits
Data bus high-order bits
Note: Pointer is incremented by a DMA request.
Figure 1.12.1. Block diagram of DMAC
Either a write signal to the software DMA request bit or an interrupt request signal is used as a DMA transfer
request signal. But the DMA transfer is affected neither by the interrupt enable flag (I flag) nor by the
interrupt priority level. The DMA transfer doesn't affect any interrupts either.
If the DMAC is active (the DMA enable bit is set to 1), data transfer starts every time a DMA transfer request
signal occurs. If the cycle of the occurrences of DMA transfer request signals is higher than the DMA
transfer cycle, there can be instances in which the number of transfer requests doesn't agree with the
number of transfers. For details, see the description of the DMA request bit.
55
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
DMAC
Table 1.12.1. DMAC specifications
Item
No. of channels
Transfer memory space
Maximum No. of bytes transferred
Specification
2 (cycle steal method)
• From any address in the 1M bytes space to a fixed address
• From a fixed address to any address in the 1M bytes space
• From a fixed address to a fixed address
(Note that DMA-related registers [002016 to 003F16] cannot be accessed)
128K bytes (with 16-bit transfers) or 64K bytes (with 8-bit transfers)
________
________
DMA request factors (Note)
Falling edge of INT0 or INT1 or both edge
Timer A0 to timer A7 interrupt requests
Timer B0 to timer B5 interrupt requests
UART0 transfer and reception interrupt requests
UART1 transfer and reception interrupt requests
UART2 transfer and reception interrupt requests
A-D conversion interrupt requests
Software triggers
Channel priority
DMA0 takes precedence if DMA0 and DMA1 requests are generated simultaneously
Transfer unit
8 bits or 16 bits
Transfer address direction
forward/fixed (forward direction cannot be specified for both source and
destination simultaneously)
Transfer mode
• Single transfer mode
After the transfer counter underflows, the DMA enable bit turns to
“0”, and the DMAC turns inactive
• Repeat transfer mode
After the transfer counter underflows, the value of the transfer counter
reload register is reloaded to the transfer counter.
The DMAC remains active unless a “0” is written to the DMA enable bit.
DMA interrupt request generation timing When an underflow occurs in the transfer counter
Active
When the DMA enable bit is set to “1”, the DMAC is active.
When the DMAC is active, data transfer starts every time a DMA
transfer request signal occurs.
Inactive
• When the DMA enable bit is set to “0”, the DMAC is inactive.
• After the transfer counter underflows in single transfer mode
At the time of starting data transfer immediately after turning the DMAC active, the
value of one of source pointer and destination pointer - the one specified for the
Forward address pointer and
forward direction - is reloaded to the forward direction address pointer, and the value
reload timing for transfer
of the transfer counter reload register is reloaded to the transfer counter.
counter
Writing to register
Registers specified for forward direction transfer are always write enabled.
Registers specified for fixed address transfer are write-enabled when
the DMA enable bit is “0”.
Reading the register
Can be read at any time.
However, when the DMA enable bit is “1”, reading the register set up as the
forward register is the same as reading the value of the forward address pointer.
Note: DMA transfer is not effective to any interrupt. DMA transfer is affected neither by the interrupt enable
flag (I flag) nor by the interrupt priority level.
56
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
DMAC
DMA0 request cause select register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
DM0SL
Bit symbol
DSEL0
Address
03B816
When reset
0016
Function
Bit name
DMA request cause
select bit
DSEL1
DSEL2
DSEL3
b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0 : Falling edge of INT0 pin
0 0 0 1 : Software trigger
0 0 1 0 : Timer A0
0 0 1 1 : Timer A1
0 1 0 0 : Timer A2
0 1 0 1 : Timer A3
0 1 1 0 : Timer A4 (DMS=0)
/two edges of INT0 pin (DMS=1)
0 1 1 1 : Timer B0 (DMS=0)
/Timer B3 (DMS=1)
1 0 0 0 : Timer B1 (DMS=0)
/Timer B4 (DMS=1)
1 0 0 1 : Timer B2 (DMS=0)
/Timer B5 (DMS=1)
1 0 1 0 : UART0 transmit
1 0 1 1 : UART0 receive
1 1 0 0 : UART2 transmit
1 1 0 1 : UART2 receive
1 1 1 0 : A-D conversion
1 1 1 1 : UART1 transmit
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
DMS
DMA request cause
expansion bit
0 : Normal
1 : Expanded cause
DSR
Software DMA
request bit
If software trigger is selected, a
DMA request is generated by
setting this bit to “1” (When read,
the value of this bit is always “0”)
AA
A
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
A
A
AA
R
W
Figure 1.12.2. DMAC register (1)
57
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
DMAC
DMA1 request cause select register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
DM1SL
Address
03BA16
Function
Bit name
Bit symbol
DSEL0
When reset
0016
DMA request cause
select bit
DSEL1
DSEL2
DSEL3
b3 b2 b1 b0
AA
AA
AAAA
AAAA
AAAA
AAAA
AAAA
AAAA
R
W
0 0 0 0 : Falling edge of INT1 pin
0 0 0 1 : Software trigger
0 0 1 0 : Timer A0
0 0 1 1 : Timer A1
0 1 0 0 : Timer A2(DMS=0)
/timer A5(DMS=1)
0 1 0 1 : Timer A3(DMS=0)
/timer A6 (DMS=1)
0 1 1 0 : Timer A4 (DMS=0)
/timer A7 (DMS=1)
0 1 1 1 : Timer B0 (DMS=0)
/two edges of INT1 (DMS=1)
1 0 0 0 : Timer B1
1 0 0 1 : Timer B2
1 0 1 0 : UART0 transmit
1 0 1 1 : UART0 receive
1 1 0 0 : UART2 transmit
1 1 0 1 : UART2 receive
1 1 1 0 : A-D conversion
1 1 1 1 : UART1 receive
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
DMS
DMA request cause
expansion bit
0 : Normal
1 : Expanded cause
DSR
Software DMA
request bit
If software trigger is selected, a
DMA request is generated by
setting this bit to “1” (When read,
the value of this bit is always “0”)
DMAi control register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
DMiCON(i=0,1)
Bit symbol
Address
002C16, 003C16
When reset
00000X002
Bit name
Function
DMBIT
Transfer unit bit select bit
0 : 16 bits
1 : 8 bits
DMASL
Repeat transfer mode
select bit
0 : Single transfer
1 : Repeat transfer
DMAS
DMA request bit (Note 1)
0 : DMA not requested
1 : DMA requested
DMAE
DMA enable bit
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
DSD
Source address direction
select bit (Note 3)
0 : Fixed
1 : Forward
DAD
Destination address
0 : Fixed
direction select bit (Note 3) 1 : Forward
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
AA
A
A
AA
A
A
AAAA
AA
A
A
AA
A
A
AAAA
AAAA
R
W
(Note 2)
Note 1: DMA request can be cleared by resetting the bit.
Note 2: This bit can only be set to “0”.
Note 3: Source address direction select bit and destination address direction select bit
cannot be set to “1” simultaneously.
Figure 1.12.3. DMAC register (2)
58
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
DMAC
DMAi source pointer (i = 0, 1)
(b23)
b7
(b19)
b3
(b16)(b15)
b0 b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
SAR0
SAR1
Address
002216 to 002016
003216 to 003016
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Transfer count
specification
Function
• Source pointer
Stores the source address
R W
AA
0000016 to FFFFF16
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
DMAi destination pointer (i = 0, 1)
(b23)
b7
(b19)
b3
(b16)(b15)
b0 b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
DAR0
DAR1
Address
002616 to 002416
003616 to 003416
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Transfer count
specification
Function
• Destination pointer
Stores the destination address
AAAA
R W
0000016 to FFFFF16
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
DMAi transfer counter (i = 0, 1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TCR0
TCR1
Address
002916, 002816
003916, 003816
Function
• Transfer counter
Set a value one less than the transfer count
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Transfer count
specification
000016 to FFFF16
AA
R W
Figure 1.12.4. DMAC register (3)
59
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
DMAC
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
(1) Transfer cycle
The transfer cycle consists of the bus cycle in which data is read from memory or from the SFR area
(source read) and the bus cycle in which the data is written to memory or to the SFR area (destination
write). The number of read and write bus cycles depends on the source and destination addresses. Also,
the bus cycle itself is longer when software waits are inserted.
(a) Effect of source and destination addresses
When 16-bit data is transferred on a 16-bit data bus, and the source and destination both start at odd
addresses, there are one more source read cycle and destination write cycle than when the source
and destination both start at even addresses.
(b) Effect of software wait
When the SFR area or a memory area with a software wait is accessed, the number of cycles is
increased for the wait by 1 bus cycle. The length of the cycle is determined by BCLK.
Figure 1.12.5 shows the example of the transfer cycles for a source read. For convenience, the destination write cycle is shown as one cycle and the source read cycles for the different conditions are shown.
In reality, the destination write cycle is subject to the same conditions as the source read cycle, with the
transfer cycle changing accordingly. When calculating the transfer cycle, remember to apply the respective conditions to both the destination write cycle and the source read cycle.
60
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
DMAC
(1) 8-bit transfers
16-bit transfers from even address and the source address is even.
BCLK
(Internal signal)
Address bus
(Internal signal)
CPU use
Source
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
RD signal
(Internal signal)
WR signal
(Internal signal)
Data bus
(Internal signal)
CPU use
Source
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
(2) 16-bit transfers and the source address is odd
BCLK
(Internal signal)
Address bus
(Internal signal)
CPU use
Source
Source + 1 Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
RD signal
(Internal signal)
WR signal
(Internal signal)
Data bus
(Internal signal)
CPU use
Source + 1 Destination
Source
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
(3) One wait is inserted into the source read under the conditions in (1)
BCLK
(Internal signal)
Address bus
(Internal signal)
CPU use
Source
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
RD signal
(Internal signal)
WR signal
(Internal signal)
Data bus
(Internal signal)
CPU use
Source
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
(4) One wait is inserted into the source read under the conditions in (2)
BCLK
(Internal signal)
Address bus
(Internal signal)
CPU use
Source
Source + 1
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
RD signal
(Internal signal)
WR signal
(Internal signal)
Data bus
(Internal signal)
CPU use
Source
Source + 1
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
Note: The same timing changes occur with the respective conditions at the destination as at the source.
Figure 1.12.5. Example of the transfer cycles for a source read
61
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
DMAC
(2) DMAC transfer cycles
Any combination of even or odd transfer read and write addresses is possible. Table 1.12.2 shows the
number of DMAC transfer cycles.
The number of DMAC transfer cycles can be calculated as follows:
No. of transfer cycles per transfer unit = No. of read cycles x j + No. of write cycles x k
Table 1.12.2. No. of DMAC transfer cycles
Transfer unit
8-bit transfers
(DMBIT= “1”)
16-bit transfers
(DMBIT= “0”)
Access address
Even
Odd
Even
Odd
No. of read cycles
1
1
1
2
No. of read cycles
1
1
1
2
Coefficient j, k
Internal ROM/RAM
No wait
1
62
Internal memory
Internal ROM/RAM
With wait
2
SFR area
2
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
DMAC
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
DMA enable bit
Setting the DMA enable bit to "1" makes the DMAC active. The DMAC carries out the following operations
at the time data transfer starts immediately after DMAC is turned active.
(1) Reloads the value of one of the source pointer and the destination pointer - the one specified for the
forward direction - to the forward direction address pointer.
(2) Reloads the value of the transfer counter reload register to the transfer counter.
Thus overwriting "1" to the DMA enable bit with the DMAC being active carries out the operations given
above, so the DMAC operates again from the initial state at the instant "1" is overwritten to the DMA
enable bit.
DMA request bit
The DMAC can generate a DMA transfer request signal triggered by a factor chosen in advance out of
DMA request factors for each channel.
DMA request factors include the following.
* Factors effected by using the interrupt request signals from the built-in peripheral functions and software
DMA factors (internal factors) effected by a program.
* External factors effected by utilizing the input from external interrupt signals.
For the selection of DMA request factors, see the descriptions of the DMAi factor selection register.
The DMA request bit turns to "1" if the DMA transfer request signal occurs regardless of the DMAC's state
(regardless of whether the DMA enable bit is set "1" or to "0"). It turns to "0" immediately before data
transfer starts.
In addition, it can be set to "0" by use of a program, but cannot be set to "1".
There can be instances in which a change in DMA request factor selection bit causes the DMA request bit
to turn to "1". So be sure to set the DMA request bit to "0" after the DMA request factor selection bit is
changed.
The DMA request bit turns to "1" if a DMA transfer request signal occurs, and turns to "0" immediately
before data transfer starts. If the DMAC is active, data transfer starts immediately, so the value of the
DMA request bit, if read by use of a program, turns out to be "0" in most cases. To examine whether the
DMAC is active, read the DMA enable bit.
Here follows the timing of changes in the DMA request bit.
(1) Internal factors
Except the DMA request factors triggered by software, the timing for the DMA request bit to turn to "1" due
to an internal factor is the same as the timing for the interrupt request bit of the interrupt control register to
turn to "1" due to several factors.
Turning the DMA request bit to "1" due to an internal factor is timed to be effected immediately before the
transfer starts.
(2) External factors
An external factor is a factor caused to occur by the leading edge of input from the INTi pin (i depends on
which DMAC channel is used).
Selecting the INTi pins as external factors using the DMA request factor selection bit causes input from
these pins to become the DMA transfer request signals.
The timing for the DMA request bit to turn to "1" when an external factor is selected synchronizes with the
signal's edge applicable to the function specified by the DMA request factor selection bit (synchronizes
with the trailing edge of the input signal to each INTi pin, for example).
With an external factor selected, the DMA request bit is timed to turn to "0" immediately before data
transfer starts similarly to the state in which an internal factor is selected.
63
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
DMAC
(3) The priorities of channels and DMA transfer timing
If a DMA transfer request signal falls on a single sampling cycle (a sampling cycle means one period from
the leading edge to the trailing edge of BCLK), the DMA request bits of applicable channels concurrently
turn to "1". If the channels are active at that moment, DMA0 is given a high priority to start data transfer.
When DMA0 finishes data transfer, it gives the bus right to the CPU. When the CPU finishes single bus
access, then DMA1 starts data transfer and gives the bus right to the CPU.
An example in which DMA transfer is carried out in minimum cycles at the time when DMA transfer
request signals due to external factors concurrently occur.
Figure 1.12.6 An example of DMA transfer effected by external factors.
An example in which DMA transmission is carried out in minimum
cycles at the time when DMA transmission request signals due to
external factors concurrently occur.
BCLK
DMA0
DMA1
CPU
INT0
AAAA
AAAA AAAA
AAAAAA
AAA
AAAAAA
AA
AAAAAA AAA AAAAAA
AA
DMA0
request bit
INT1
DMA1
request bit
Figure 1.12.6. An example of DMA transfer effected by external factors
64
Obtainm
ent of the
bus right
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer
Timer
There are fourteen 16-bit timers. These timers can be classified by function into timers A (eight) and timers
B (six). All these timers function independently. Figures 1.13.1 and 1.13.2 show the block diagram of
timers.
fC1
f1
XIN
f8
1/8
1/4
f1 f8 f32 fC132
f32
Clock prescaler
fC32
1/32
XCIN
Clock prescaler reset flag (bit 7
at address 038116) set to “1”
Reset
fC132
fc132 clock select bit
(bit 4 at address 000716)
Timer B2 overflow
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
Timer A0 interrupt
TA0IN
Noise
filter
Timer A0
• Event counter mode
Port P0 real time
output trigger
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
TA1IN
Noise
filter
Timer A1 interrupt
Timer A1
• Event counter mode
Port P1 real time
output trigger
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
Timer A2 interrupt
TA2IN
Noise
filter
Timer A2
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
Timer A3 interrupt
TA3IN
(Note 1)
Noise
filter
Timer A3
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
Timer A4 interrupt
TA4IN
(Note 2)
Noise
filter
Timer A4
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
Timer A5 interrupt
TA5IN
Noise
filter
Timer A5
• Event counter mode
Port P2 real time
output trigger
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
TA6IN
Noise
filter
Timer A6
• Event counter mode
Port P12 real time
output trigger
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
TA7IN
Noise
filter
Timer A6 interrupt
Timer A7
Timer A7 interrupt
• Event counter mode
Timer B5 overflow
Note 1: The TA3IN pin (P47) is shared with INT4 pin, so be careful.
Note 2: The TA4IN pin (P81) is shared with INT5 pin, so be careful.
Figure 1.13.1. Timer A block diagram
65
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer
fC1
f1
XIN
f8
1/8
1/4
f32
XCIN
Clock prescaler
fC32
1/32
Clock prescaler reset flag (bit 7
at address 038116) set to “1”
Reset
fC132
fc132 clock select bit
(bit 4 at address 000716)
f1 f8 f32 fC132
Timer A0 to timer A4
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
TB0IN
Timer B0 interrupt
Noise
filter
Timer B0
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
TB1IN
Noise
filter
Timer B1 interrupt
Timer B1
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
TB2IN
Noise
filter
Timer B2 interrupt
Timer B2
• Event counter mode
Timer A5 to timer A7
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
TB3IN
Noise
filter
Timer B3 interrupt
Timer B3
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
TB4IN
Noise
filter
Timer B4 interrupt
Timer B4
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
TB5IN
Noise
filter
Timer B5
• Event counter mode
Figure 1.13.2. Timer B block diagram
66
Timer B5 interrupt
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
Timer A
Figure 1.13.3 shows the block diagram of timer A. Figures 1.13.4 to 1.13.8 show the timer A-related
registers.
Use the timer Ai mode register (i = 0 to 7) bits 0 and 1 to choose the desired mode.
Timer A has the four operation modes listed as follows:
• Timer mode: The timer counts an internal count source.
• Event counter mode: The timer counts pulses from an external source or a timer over flow.
• One-shot timer mode: The timer stops counting when the count reaches “000016”.
• Pulse width modulation (PWM) mode: The timer outputs pulses of a given width.
Data bus high-order bits
Clock source
selection
Data bus low-order bits
• Timer
• One shot
• PWM
f1
f8
f32
fC132
High-order
8 bits
Low-order
8 bits
• Timer
(gate function)
Reload register (16)
• Event counter
Counter (16)
Polarity
selection
Up count/down count
Clock selection
TAiIN
(i = 0 to 7)
Always down count except
in event counter mode
Count start flag
(Address 0340 16, 038016)
Down count
TBm overflow
(m = 2 when i £ 4, m = 5 when i ³ 5)
External
trigger
TAj overflow
(j = i –1. Note, however, that j = 4 when i = 0,
j = 6 when i = 5, j = 5 when i = 7)
Up/down flag
(Address 0344 16, 038416)
TAk overflow
(k = i + 1. Note, however, that k = 0 when i = 4,
k = 7 when i = 5, k = 6 when i = 7)
Pulse output
TAi OUT
(i = 0 to 7)
TAi
Timer A0
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
Timer A4
Timer A5
Timer A6
Timer A7
Addresses
038716 038616
038916 038816
038B 16 038A16
038D16 038C16
038F 16 038E16
034716 034616
034916 034816
034B 16 034A16
TAj
Timer A4
Timer A0
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
Timer A7
Timer A5
Timer A6
TAk
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
Timer A4
Timer A0
Timer A6
Timer A7
Timer A5
TAm
Timer B2
Timer B2
Timer B2
Timer B2
Timer B2
Timer B5
Timer B5
Timer B5
Toggle flip-flop
Figure 1.13.3. Block diagram of timer A
Timer Ai mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TAiMR(i=0 to 4)
TAiMR(i=5 to 7)
Bit symbol
TMOD0
MR1
When reset
0016
0016
Bit name
Operation mode select bit
TMOD1
MR0
Address
039616 to 039A16
035616 to 035816
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : Timer mode
0 1 : Event counter mode
1 0 : One-shot timer mode
1 1 : Pulse width modulation
(PWM) mode
Function varies with each operation mode
MR2
MR3
TCK0
TCK1
Count source select bit
(Function varies with each operation mode)
Figure 1.13.4. Timer A-related registers (1)
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
RW
67
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
Timer Ai register (Note)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
Symbol
TA0
TA1
TA2
TA3
TA4
TA5
TA6
TA7
b0
Address
038716,038616
038916,038816
038B16,038A16
038D16,038C16
038F16,038E16
034716,034616
034916,034816
034B16,034A16
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
A
A
A
Function
Values that can be set
• Timer mode
Counts an internal count source
000016 to FFFF16
RW
• Event counter mode
000016 to FFFF16
Counts pulses from an external source or timer overflow
• One-shot timer mode
Counts a one shot width
000016 to FFFF16
• Pulse width modulation mode (16-bit PWM)
Functions as a 16-bit pulse width modulator
000016 to FFFE16
• Pulse width modulation mode (8-bit PWM)
Timer low-order address functions as an 8-bit
prescaler and high-order address functions as an 8-bit
pulse width modulator
0016 to FE16
(Both high-order
and low-order
addresses)
Note: Read and write data in 16-bit units.
Count start flag 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TABSR0
Address
038016
When reset
0016
A
A
A
AA
A
A
AA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
Bit symbol
Bit name
TA0S
Timer A0 count start flag
TA1S
Timer A1 count start flag
TA2S
Timer A2 count start flag
TA3S
Timer A3 count start flag
TA4S
Timer A4 count start flag
TB0S
Timer B0 count start flag
TB1S
Timer B1 count start flag
TB2S
Timer B2 count start flag
Function
RW
0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
Count start flag 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TABSR1
Address
034016
When reset
000XX0002
AA
A
AA
A
A
AA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
A
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
Bit symbol
Bit name
TA5S
Timer A5 count start flag
TA6S
Timer A6 count start flag
TA7S
Timer A7 count start flag
Function
0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
TB3S
Timer B3 count start flag
TB4S
Timer B4 count start flag
TB5S
Timer B5 count start flag
Figure 1.13.5. Timer A-related registers (2)
68
0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
RW
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
Up/down flag 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UDF0
Address
038416
Bit symbol
When reset
0016
Bit name
TA0UD
Timer A0 up/down flag
TA1UD
Timer A1 up/down flag
TA2UD
Timer A2 up/down flag
TA3UD
Timer A3 up/down flag
TA4UD
Timer A4 up/down flag
Function
0 : Down count
1 : Up count
This specification becomes valid
when the up/down flag content is
selected for up/down switching
cause
Timer A2 two-phase pulse 0 : two-phase pulse signal
processing disabled
signal processing select bit
1 : two-phase pulse signal
processing enabled
Timer A3 two-phase pulse
signal processing select bit
When not using the two-phase
Timer A4 two-phase pulse pulse signal processing function,
signal processing select bit set the select bit to “0”
TA2P
TA3P
TA4P
AAA
AAAA
AAAA
AA
AA
AA
AA
R W
Up/down flag 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UDF1
Address
034416
Bit symbol
When reset
XX0XX0002
Bit name
TA5UD
Timer A5 up/down flag
TA6UD
Timer A6 up/down flag
TA7UD
Timer A7 up/down flag
Function
0 : Down count
1 : Up count
This specification becomes valid
when the up/down flag content is
selected for up/down switching
cause
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
TA7P
Timer A7 two-phase pulse 0 : two-phase pulse signal
processing disabled
signal processing select bit
1 : two-phase pulse signal
processing enabled
When not using the two-phase
pulse signal processing function,
set the select bit to “0”
AA
A
AA
AAA
AA
A
AA
R W
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
One-shot start flag 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
ONSF0
Bit symbol
Address
038216
When reset
00X000002
Bit name
TA0OS
Timer A0 one-shot start flag
TA1OS
Timer A1 one-shot start flag
TA2OS
Timer A2 one-shot start flag
TA3OS
Timer A3 one-shot start flag
TA4OS
Timer A4 one-shot start flag
Function
1 : Timer start
When read, the value is “0”
AAA
AA
A
AAAA
AA
AAAA
AA
RW
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate.
TA0TGL
Timer A0 event/trigger
select bit
TA0TGH
b7 b6
0 0 : Input on TA0IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA4 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA1 overflow is selected
Note: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Figure 1.13.6. Timer A-related registers (3)
69
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
One-shot start flag 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
ONSF1
b0
Address
034216
When reset
00XXX0002
Bit symbol
Bit name
TA5OS
Timer A5 one-shot start flag
Function
TA6OS
Timer A6 one-shot start flag
TA7OS
Timer A7 one-shot start flag
1 : Timer start
When read, the value is “0”
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
TA5TGL
Timer A5 event/trigger
select bit
TA5TGH
b7 b6
0 0 : Input on TA5IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB5 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA6 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA7 overflow is selected
AAA
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
RW
Note: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Trigger select register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
TRGSR0
b0
Address
038316
Bit symbol
TA1TGL
Bit name
b1 b0
Timer A2 event/trigger
select bit
b3 b2
TA2TGH
TA3TGL
Timer A3 event/trigger
select bit
TA3TGH
TA4TGL
Function
Timer A1 event/trigger
select bit
TA1TGH
TA2TGL
When reset
0016
Timer A4 event/trigger
select bit
TA4TGH
0 0 : Input on TA1IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA0 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA2 overflow is selected
0 0 : Input on TA2IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA1 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA3 overflow is selected
b5 b4
0 0 : Input on TA3IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA2 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA4 overflow is selected
b7 b6
0 0 : Input on TA4IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA3 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA0 overflow is selected
Note: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
AAA
AAA
AA
AAA
AAAA
AA
AAA
AA
AAA
A
R W
Trigger select register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TRGSR1
Bit symbol
TA6TGL
Address
034316
Bit name
Timer A6 event/trigger
select bit
TA6TGH
TA7TGL
Timer A7 event/trigger
select bit
TA7TGH
When reset
XXXX00002
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : Input on TA6IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB5 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA5 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA7 overflow is selected
b3 b2
0 0 : Input on TA7IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB5 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA5 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA6 overflow is selected
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
Note: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Figure 1.13.7. Timer A-related registers (4)
70
AA
AAAA
AA
R W
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
Clock prescaler reset flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
CPSRF
Address
038116
Bit symbol
Bit name
When reset
0XXXXXXX2
Function
RW
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
CPSR
Clock prescaler reset flag
0 : No effect
1 : Prescaler is reset
(When read, the value is “0”)
Figure 1.13.8. Timer A-related registers (5)
71
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
(1) Timer mode
In this mode, the timer counts an internally generated count source. (See Table 1.13.1.) Figure 1.13.9
shows the timer Ai mode register in timer mode.
Table 1.13.1. Specifications of timer mode
Item
Count source
Count operation
Specification
f1, f8, f32, fC132
• Down count
• When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents before continuing counting
1/(n+1) n : Set value
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
When the timer underflows
Programmable I/O port or gate input
Programmable I/O port or pulse output
Count value can be read out by reading timer Ai register
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
• Gate function
Counting can be started and stopped by the TAiIN pin’s input signal
• Pulse output function
Each time the timer underflows, the TAiOUT pin’s polarity is reversed
Divide ratio
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TAiIN pin function
TAiOUT pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select function
Timer Ai mode register
b7
b6
b5
0
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0
Symbol
TAiMR(i=0 to 4)
TAiMR(i=5 to 7)
Bit symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Address
When reset
0016
039616 to 039A16
035616 to 035816
0016
Bit name
Operation mode
select bit
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : Timer mode
MR0
Pulse output function
select bit
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin)
1 : Pulse is output (Note 1)
(TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin)
MR1
Gate function select bit
b4 b3
0 X (Note 2): Gate function not available
(TAiIN pin is a normal port pin)
1 0 : Timer counts only when TAiIN pin is
held “L” (Note 3)
1 1 : Timer counts only when TAiIN pin is
held “H” (Note 3)
MR2
MR3
0 (Must always be fixed to “0” in timer mode)
TCK0
Count source select bit
TCK1
b7 b6
0 0 : f1
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC132
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
RW
Note 1: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register
are invalid.
Note 2: The bit can be “0” or “1”.
Note 3: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0” (input mode).
Figure 1.13.9. Timer Ai mode register in timer mode
72
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
(2) Event counter mode
In this mode, the timer counts an external signal or an internal timer’s overflow. Timers A0, A1, A5 and A6
can count a single-phase external signal. Timers A2, A3, A4 and A7 can count a single-phase and a twophase external signal. Table 1.13.2 lists timer specifications when counting a single-phase external
signal. Figure 1.13.10 shows the timer Ai mode register in event counter mode.
Table 1.13.3 lists timer specifications when counting a two-phase external signal. Figure 1.13.11 shows
the timer Ai mode register in event counter mode.
Table 1.13.2. Timer specifications in event counter mode (when not processing two-phase pulse signal)
Item
Specification
Count source
• External signals input to TAiIN pin (effective edge can be selected by software)
• TB2 overflow, TB5 overflow, TAj overflow
Count operation
• Up count or down count can be selected by external signal or software
• When the timer overflows or underflows, it reloads the reload register con
tents before continuing counting (Note)
Divide ratio
1/ (FFFF16 - n + 1) for up count
1/ (n + 1) for down count
n : Set value
Count start condition
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count stop condition
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
Interrupt request generation timing The timer overflows or underflows
TAiIN pin function
Programmable I/O port or count source input
TAiOUT pin function
Programmable I/O port, pulse output, or up/down count select input
Read from timer
Count value can be read out by reading timer Ai register
Write to timer
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
Select function
• Free-run count function
Even when the timer overflows or underflows, the reload register content is not reloaded to it
• Pulse output function
Each time the timer overflows or underflows, the TAiOUT pin’s polarity is reversed
Note: This does not apply when the free-run function is selected.
Timer Ai mode register
b7
b6
b5
0
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
TAiMR(i = 0, 1)
TAiMR(i = 5, 6)
b0
0 1
Address
039616, 039716
035616, 035716
When reset
0016
0016
Bit symbol
Bit name
TMOD0
Operation mode select bit
b1 b0
Function
MR0
Pulse output function
select bit
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin)
1 : Pulse is output (Note 2)
(TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin)
MR1
Count polarity
select bit (Note 3)
0 : Counts external signal's falling edge
1 : Counts external signal's rising edge
MR2
Up/down switching
cause select bit
0 : Up/down flag's content
1 : TAiOUT pin's input signal (Note 4)
0 1 : Event counter mode (Note 1)
TMOD1
MR3
0 (Must always be fixed to “0” in event counter mode)
TCK0
Count operation type
select bit
TCK1
Invalid in event counter mode
Can be “0” or “1”
0 : Reload type
1 : Free-run type
AA
AAAA
AAA
AA
AAA
AAAA
AA
RW
Note 1: In event counter mode, the count source is selected by the event / trigger select bit .
Note 2: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid.
Note 3: Valid only when counting an external signal.
Note 4: When an “L” signal is input to the TAiOUT pin, the downcount is activated. When “H”,
the upcount is activated. Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Figure 1.13.10. Timer Ai mode register in event counter mode
73
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
Table 1.13.3. Timer specifications in event counter mode (when processing two-phase pulse signal with timers A2, A3, A4 and A7)
Item
Count source
Count operation
Divide ratio
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TAiIN pin function
TAiOUT pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select function
Specification
• Two-phase pulse signals input to TAiIN or TAiOUT pin
• Up count or down count can be selected by two-phase pulse signal
• When the timer overflows or underflows, the reload register content is
reloaded and the timer starts over again (Note)
1/ (FFFF16 - n + 1) for up count
1/ (n + 1) for down count
n : Set value
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
Timer overflows or underflows
Two-phase pulse input
Two-phase pulse input
Count value can be read out by reading timer A2, A3, A4 or A7 register
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer A2, A3, A4 or A7 register, it is written to both
reload register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer A2, A3, A4 or A7 register, it is written to only
reload register. (Transferred to counter at next reload time.)
• Normal processing operation
The timer counts up rising edges or counts down falling edges on the TAiIN
pin when input signal on the TAiOUT pin is “H”
TAiOUT
TAiIN
(i=2, 3, 7)
Up
count
Up
count
Up
count
Down
count
Down
count
Down
count
• Multiply-by-4 processing operation
If the phase relationship is such that the TAiIN pin goes “H” when the input
signal on the TAiOUT pin is “H”, the timer counts up rising and falling edges
on the TAiOUT and TAiIN pins. If the phase relationship is such that the
TAiIN pin goes “L” when the input signal on the TAiOUT pin is “H”, the timer
counts down rising and falling edges on the TAiOUT and TAiIN pins.
TAiOUT
Count up all edges
Count down all edges
Count up all edges
Count down all edges
TAiIN
(i=3, 4)
Note: This does not apply when the free-run function is selected.
74
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
Timer Ai mode register
(When not using two-phase pulse signal processing)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
0
b1
b0
0 1
Symbol
Address
When reset
TAiMR(i = 2 to 4) 039816 to 039A16
0016
TA7MR
035816
0016
Bit symbol
TMOD0
Bit name
Operation mode select bit
TMOD1
Function
b1 b0
0 1 : Event counter mode
MR0
Pulse output function
select bit
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin)
1 : Pulse is output (Note 1)
(TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin)
MR1
Count polarity
select bit (Note 2)
0 : Counts external signal's falling edges
1 : Counts external signal's rising edges
MR2
Up/down switching
cause select bit
0 : Up/down flag's content
1 : TAiOUT pin's input signal (Note 3)
MR3
0 : (Must always be “0” in event counter mode)
TCK0
Count operation type
select bit
0 : Reload type
1 : Free-run type
TCK1
Two-phase pulse signal
processing operation
select bit (Note 4)(Note 5)
0 : Normal processing operation
1 : Multiply-by-4 processing operation
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
R W
Note 1: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid.
Note 2: This bit is valid when only counting an external signal.
Note 3: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Note 4: This bit is valid for the timer A3 mode register.
For timer A2, A4 and A7 mode registers, this bit can be “0 ”or “1”.
Note 5: When performing two-phase pulse signal processing, make sure the two-phase pulse
signal processing operation select bit (addresses 038416 and 034416) is set to “1”.
Also, always be sure to set the event/trigger select bit (addresses 038316 and 034316)
to “00”.
Timer Ai mode register
(When using two-phase pulse signal processing)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 1 0 0 0 1
Symbol
Address
When reset
TAiMR(i = 2 to 4) 039816 to 039A16
0016
TA7MR
035816
0016
Bit symbol
Bit name
TMOD0
TMOD1
Operation mode select bit
Function
b1 b0
0 1 : Event counter mode
MR0
0 (Must always be “0” when using two-phase pulse signal
processing)
MR1
0 (Must always be “0” when using two-phase pulse signal
processing)
MR2
1 (Must always be “1” when using two-phase pulse signal
processing)
MR3
0 (Must always be “0” when using two-phase pulse signal
processing)
TCK0
Count operation type
select bit
0 : Reload type
1 : Free-run type
TCK1
Two-phase pulse
processing operation
select bit (Note 1)(Note 2)
0 : Normal processing operation
1 : Multiply-by-4 processing operation
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
RW
Note 1 : This bit is valid for timer A3 mode register.
For timer A2, A4, and A7 mode registers, this bit can be “0” or “1”.
Note 2 : When performing two-phase pulse signal processing, make sure the two-phase pulse
signal processing operation select bit (addresses 038416 and 034416) is set to “1”.
Also, always be sure to set the event/trigger select bit (addresses 038316 and 034316)
to “00”.
Figure 1.13.11. Timer Ai mode register in event counter mode
75
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
(3) One-shot timer mode
In this mode, the timer operates only once. (See Table 1.13.4.) When a trigger occurs, the timer starts up
and continues operating for a given period. Figure 1.13.12 shows the timer Ai mode register in one-shot
timer mode.
Table 1.13.4. Timer specifications in one-shot timer mode
Item
Count source
Count operation
Specification
Divide ratio
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TAiIN pin function
TAiOUT pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
f1, f8, f32, fC132
• The timer counts down
• When the count reaches 000016, the timer stops counting after reloading a new count
• If a trigger occurs when counting, the timer reloads a new count and restarts counting
1/n
n : Set value
• An external trigger is input
• The timer overflows
• The one-shot start flag is set (= 1)
• A new count is reloaded after the count has reached 000016
• The count start flag is reset (= 0)
The count reaches 000016
Programmable I/O port or trigger input
Programmable I/O port or pulse output
When timer Ai register is read, it indicates an indeterminate value
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload
register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
Timer Ai mode register
b7
b6
b5
0
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 0
Symbol
Address
When reset
TAiMR(i = 0 to 4) 039616 to 039A16
0016
TAiMR(i = 5 to 7) 035616 to 035816
0016
AA
AAAA
AA
AA
AAA
A
AA
AAAA
Bit symbol
Bit name
TMOD0
Operation mode select bit
b1 b0
MR0
Pulse output function
select bit
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin)
1 : Pulse is output (Note 1)
(TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin)
MR1
External trigger select
bit (Note 2)
0 : Falling edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 3)
1 : Rising edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 3)
MR2
Trigger select bit
0 : One-shot start flag is valid
1 : Selected by event/trigger select
register
TMOD1
Function
1 0 : One-shot timer mode
MR3
0 (Must always be “0” in one-shot timer mode)
TCK0
Count source select bit
TCK1
b7 b6
0 0 : f1
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC132
RW
Note 1: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid.
Note 2: Valid only when the TAiIN pin is selected by the event/trigger select bit
(addresses 034216, 034316, 038216 and 038316). If timer overflow is selected,
this bit can be “1” or “0” .
Note 3: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0” (input mode).
Figure 1.13.12. Timer Ai mode register in one-shot timer mode
76
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
(4) Pulse width modulation (PWM) mode
In this mode, the timer outputs pulses of a given width in succession. (See Table 1.13.5.) In this mode, the
counter functions as either a 16-bit pulse width modulator or an 8-bit pulse width modulator. Figure
1.13.13 shows the timer Ai mode register in pulse width modulation mode. Figure 1.13.14 shows the
example of how a 16-bit pulse width modulator operates. Figure 1.13.15 shows the example of how an 8bit pulse width modulator operates.
Table 1.13.5. Timer specifications in pulse width modulation mode
Item
Specification
Count source
Count operation
f1, f8, f32, fC132
• The timer counts down (operating as an 8-bit or a 16-bit pulse width modulator)
• The timer reloads a new count at a rising edge of PWM pulse and continues counting
• The timer is not affected by a trigger that occurs when counting
• High level width
n / fi n : Set value
• Cycle time
(216-1) / fi fixed
• High level width n (m+1) / fi
n : values set to timer Ai register’s high-order address
• Cycle time
(28-1) (m+1) / fi
m : values set to timer Ai register’s low-order address
• External trigger is input
• The timer overflows
• The count start flag is set (= 1)
• The count start flag is reset (= 0)
PWM pulse goes “L”
Programmable I/O port or trigger input
Pulse output
When timer Ai register is read, it indicates an indeterminate value
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload
register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
16-bit PWM
8-bit PWM
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TAiIN pin function
TAiOUT pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Timer Ai mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 1
1
Symbol
TAiMR(i=0 to 4)
TAiMR(i=5 to 7)
Bit symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Address
When reset
039616 to 039A16
0016
035616 to 035816
0016
Bit name
Operation mode
select bit
Function
b1 b0
1 1 : PWM mode
AA
AAAA
AAAA
AA
AA
AA
AA
MR0
1 (Must always be “1” in PWM mode)
MR1
External trigger select
bit (Note 1)
0: Falling edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 2)
1: Rising edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 2)
MR2
Trigger select bit
0: Count start flag is valid
1: Selected by event/trigger select register
MR3
16/8-bit PWM mode
select bit
0: Functions as a 16-bit pulse width modulator
1: Functions as an 8-bit pulse width modulator
TCK0
Count source select bit
0 0 : f1
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC132
b7 b6
TCK1
R W
Note 1: Valid only when the TAiIN pin is selected by the event/trigger select bit
(addresses 034216, 034316, 038216 and 038316 ). If timer overflow is selected,
this bit can be “1” or “0”.
Note 2: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0” (input mode).
Figure 1.13.13. Timer Ai mode register in pulse width modulation mode
77
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer A
Condition : Reload register = 000316, when external trigger
(rising edge of TAiIN pin input signal) is selected
1 / fi X (2 16 – 1)
Count source
“H”
TAiIN pin
input signal
“L”
Trigger is not generated by this signal
1 / fi X n
PWM pulse output
from TAiOUT pin
“H”
Timer Ai interrupt
request bit
“1”
“L”
“0”
fi : Frequency of count source
(f1, f8, f32, fC132)
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Note: n = 000016 to FFFE16.
Figure 1.13.14. Example of how a 16-bit pulse width modulator operates
Condition : Reload register high-order 8 bits = 0216
Reload register low-order 8 bits = 0216
External trigger (falling edge of TAiIN pin input signal) is selected
1 / fi X (m + 1) X (2 8 – 1)
Count source (Note1)
TAiIN pin input signal
“H”
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
“L”
1 / fi X (m + 1)
“H”
Underflow signal of
8-bit prescaler (Note2) “L”
1 / fi X (m + 1) X n
PWM pulse output
from TAiOUT pin
“H”
Timer Ai interrupt
request bit
“1”
“L”
“0”
fi : Frequency of count source
(f1, f8, f32, fC132)
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleaerd by software
Note 1: The 8-bit prescaler counts the count source.
Note 2: The 8-bit pulse width modulator counts the 8-bit prescaler's underflow signal.
Note 3: m = 0016 to FE16; n = 0016 to FE16.
Figure 1.13.15. Example of how an 8-bit pulse width modulator operates
78
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer B
Timer B
Figure 1.13.16 shows the block diagram of timer B. Figures 1.13.17 and 1.13.18 show the timer B-related
registers.
Use the timer Bi mode register (i = 0 to 5) bits 0 and 1 to choose the desired mode.
Timer B has three operation modes listed as follows:
• Timer mode: The timer counts an internal count source.
• Event counter mode: The timer counts pulses from an external source or a timer overflow.
• Pulse period/pulse width measuring mode: The timer measures an external signal's pulse period or
pulse width.
Data bus high-order bits
Data bus low-order bits
Clock source selection
High-order 8 bits
Low-order 8 bits
f1
• Timer
• Pulse period/pulse width measurement
f8
f32
fC132
Reload register (16)
Counter (16)
• Event counter
Count start flag
Polarity switching
and edge pulse
TBiIN
(i = 0 to 5)
(address 038016)
Counter reset circuit
Can be selected in only
event counter mode
TBi
Timer B0
Timer B1
Timer B2
Timer B3
Timer B4
Timer B5
TBj overflow
(j = i – 1. Note, however,
j = 2 when i = 0,
j = 5 when i = 3)
Address
039116 039016
039316 039216
039516 039416
035116 035016
035316 035216
035516 035416
TBj
Timer B2
Timer B0
Timer B1
Timer B5
Timer B3
Timer B4
Figure 1.13.16. Block diagram of timer B
Timer Bi mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
TBiMR(i = 0 to 2) 039B16 to 039D16
TBiMR(i = 3 to 5) 035B16 to 035D16
Bit symbol
TMOD0
Function
Bit name
Operation mode select bit
TMOD1
MR0
When reset
00XX00002
00XX00002
b1 b0
0 0 : Timer mode
0 1 : Event counter mode
1 0 : Pulse period/pulse width
measurement mode
1 1 : Inhibited
Function varies with each operation mode
MR1
MR2
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AAA
R
W
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
MR3
TCK0
TCK1
Count source select bit
(Function varies with each operation mode)
Note 1: Timer B0, timer B3.
Note 2: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5.
Figure 1.13.17. Timer B-related registers (1)
79
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer B
Timer Bi register (Note)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
Symbol
TB0
TB1
TB2
TB3
TB4
TB5
b0
Address
039116, 039016
039316, 039216
039516, 039416
035116, 035016
035316, 035216
035516, 035416
Function
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
AAAA
AA
AA
Values that can be set
• Timer mode
Counts the timer's period
000016 to FFFF16
• Event counter mode
Counts external pulses input or a timer overflow
000016 to FFFF16
• Pulse period / pulse width measurement mode
Measures a pulse period or width
Note: Read and write data in 16-bit units.
RW
Count start flag 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TABSR 0
Address
038016
When reset
0016
Count start flag 1
AA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
AAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAA
AA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
A
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
b7
b0
Bit name
Bit symbol
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
TA0S
Timer A0 count start flag
TA1S
Timer A1 count start flag
TA2S
Timer A2 count start flag
TA3S
Timer A3 count start flag
TA4S
Timer A4 count start flag
TB0S
Timer B0 count start flag
TB1S
Timer B1 count start flag
TB2S
Timer B2 count start flag
Symbol
TABSR1
Address
034016
Function
RW
0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
When reset
000XX0002
AAA
A
AAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
A
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
Bit symbol
Bit name
TA5S
Timer A5 count start flag
TA6S
Timer A6 count start flag
TA7S
Timer A7 count start flag
Function
RW
0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
TB3S
Timer B3 count start flag
TB4S
Timer B4 count start flag
TB5S
Timer B5 count start flag
0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
Clock prescaler reset flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
CPSRF
Address
038116
Bit symbol
Bit name
When reset
0XXXXXXX2
Function
Nothing is assigned.
R W
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns
out to be indeterminate.
CPSR
Clock prescaler reset flag
Figure 1.13.18. Timer B-related registers (2)
80
0 : No effect
1 : Prescaler is reset
(When read, the value is “0”)
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer B
(1) Timer mode
In this mode, the timer counts an internally generated count source. (See Table 1.13.6.) Figure 1.13.19
shows the timer Bi mode register in timer mode.
Table 1.13.6. Timer specifications in timer mode
Item
Count source
Count operation
Specification
Divide ratio
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TBiIN pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
AA
A
AA
A
f1, f8, f32, fC132
• Counts down
• When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents before
continuing counting
1/(n+1) n : Set value
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
The timer underflows
Programmable I/O port
Count value is read out by reading timer Bi register
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
Timer Bi mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0
Symbol
TBiMR(i=0 to 2)
TBiMR(i=3 to 5)
Bit symbol
TMOD0
Address
039B16 to 039D16
035B16 to 035D16
Bit name
Operation mode select bit
TMOD1
MR0
MR1
MR2
When reset
00XX00002
00XX00002
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : Timer mode
Invalid in timer mode
Can be “0” or “1”
0 (Fixed to “0” in timer mode ; i = 0, 3)
Nothing is assiigned (i = 1, 2, 4, 5).
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out
to be indeterminate.
MR3
Invalid in timer mode.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read in
timer mode, turns out to be indeterminate.
TCK0
Count source select bit
TCK1
b7 b6
0 0 : f1
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC132
Note 1: Timer B0, timer B3.
Note 2: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5.
AAA
AAA
A
AA
A
AAA
AA
AAA
A
A
AAA
AAA
R
W
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
Figure 1.13.19. Timer Bi mode register in timer mode
81
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer B
(2) Event counter mode
In this mode, the timer counts an external signal or an internal timer's overflow. (See Table 1.13.7.)
Figure 1.13.20 shows the timer Bi mode register in event counter mode.
Table 1.13.7. Timer specifications in event counter mode
Item
Count source
Specification
• External signals input to TBiIN pin
• Effective edge of count source can be a rising edge, a falling edge, or falling
and rising edges as selected by software
Count operation
• Counts down
• When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents before
continuing counting
Divide ratio
1/(n+1)
n : Set value
Count start condition
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count stop condition
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
Interrupt request generation timing The timer underflows
TBiIN pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Count source input
Count value can be read out by reading timer Bi register
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
AA
AA
Timer Bi mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 1
Symbol
TBiMR(i=0 to 2)
TBiMR(i=3 to 5)
Address
039B16 to 039D16
035B16 to 035D16
Bit symbol
Bit name
TMOD0
Operation mode select bit
TMOD1
MR0
Count polarity select
bit (Note 1)
MR1
MR2
MR3
When reset
00XX00002
00XX00002
Function
b1 b0
0 1 : Event counter mode
b3 b2
0 0 : Counts external signal's
falling edges
0 1 : Counts external signal's
rising edges
1 0 : Counts external signal's
falling and rising edges
1 1 : Inhibited
0 (Fixed to “0” in event counter mode; i = 0, 3)
Nothing is assigned (i = 1, 2, 4, 5).
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read,
turns out to be indeterminate.
Invalid in event counter mode.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read in
event counter mode, turns out to be indeterminate.
TCK0
Invalid in event counter mode.
Can be “0” or “1”.
TCK1
Event clock select
0 : Input from TBiIN pin (Note 4)
1 : TBj overflow
(j = i – 1; however, j = 2 when i = 0,
j = 5 when i = 3)
AAA
A
AA
AA
AA
AAAA
A
AA
AA
Note 1: Valid only when input from the TBiIN pin is selected as the event clock.
If timer's overflow is selected, this bit can be “0” or “1”.
Note 2: Timer B0, timer B3.
Note 3: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5.
Note 4: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Figure 1.13.20. Timer Bi mode register in event counter mode
82
R
(Note 2)
(Note 3)
W
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer B
(3) Pulse period/pulse width measurement mode
In this mode, the timer measures the pulse period or pulse width of an external signal. (See Table 1.13.8.)
Figure 1.13.21 shows the timer Bi mode register in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode. Figure
1.13.22 shows the operation timing when measuring a pulse period. Figure 1.13.23 shows the operation
timing when measuring a pulse width.
Table 1.13.8. Timer specifications in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode
Item
Count source
Count operation
Specification
f1, f8, f32, fC132
• Up count
• Counter value “000016” is transferred to reload register at measurement
pulse's effective edge and the timer continues counting
Count start condition
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count stop condition
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
Interrupt request generation timing • When measurement pulse's effective edge is input (Note 1)
• When an overflow occurs. (Simultaneously, the timer Bi overflow flag
changes to “1”. The timer Bi overflow flag changes to “0” when the count
start flag is “1” and a value is written to the timer Bi mode register.)
TBiIN pin function
Measurement pulse input
Read from timer
When timer Bi register is read, it indicates the reload register’s content
(measurement result) (Note 2)
Write to timer
Cannot be written to
Note 1: An interrupt request is not generated when the first effective edge is input after the timer has started counting.
Note 2: The value read out from the timer Bi register is indeterminate until the second effective edge is input after the timer.
Timer Bi mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 0
Symbol
TBiMR(i=0 to 2)
TBiMR(i=3 to 5)
Bit symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
MR0
Address
039B16 to 039D16
035B16 to 035D16
Bit name
Operation mode
select bit
Measurement mode
select bit
MR1
MR2
When reset
00XX00002
00XX00002
Function
b1 b0
1 0 : Pulse period / pulse width
measurement mode
b3 b2
0 0 : Pulse period measurement (Interval between
measurement pulse's falling edge to falling edge)
0 1 : Pulse period measurement (Interval between
measurement pulse's rising edge to rising edge)
1 0 : Pulse width measurement (Interval between
measurement pulse's falling edge to rising edge,
and between rising edge to falling edge)
1 1 : Inhibited
0 (Fixed to “0” in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode; i = 0, 3)
W
(Note 2)
Nothing is assigned (i = 1, 2, 4, 5).
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
MR3
Timer Bi overflow
flag ( Note 1)
TCK0
Count source
select bit
TCK1
AA
AA
AAAA
AA
AA
A
AA
AA
R
0 : Timer did not overflow
1 : Timer has overflowed
b7 b6
0 0 : f1
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC132
(Note 3)
Note 1: The timer Bi overflow flag changes to “0” when the count start flag is “1” and a value is written to the
timer Bi mode register. This flag cannot be set to “1” by software.
Note 2: Timer B0, timer B3.
Note 3: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5.
Figure 1.13.21. Timer Bi mode register in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode
83
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timer B
When measuring measurement pulse time interval from falling edge to falling edge
Count source
“H”
Measurement pulse
Reload register
transfer timing
“L”
Transfer
(indeterminate value)
Transfer
(measured value)
counter
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
Timing at which counter
reaches “000016”
“1”
Count start flag
“0”
Timer Bi interrupt
request bit
“1”
Timer Bi overflow flag
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software.
“0”
Note 1: Counter is initialized at completion of measurement.
Note 2: Timer has overflowed.
Figure 1.13.22. Operation timing when measuring a pulse period
Count source
Measurement pulse
Reload register
transfer timing
“H”
“L”
counter
Transfer
(indeterminate
value)
(Note 1)
Transfer
(measured value)
Transfer
(measured
value)
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
Transfer
(measured value)
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
Timing at which counter
reaches “000016”
Count start flag
“1”
“0”
Timer Bi interrupt
request bit
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software.
Timer Bi overflow flag
“1”
“0”
Note 1: Counter is initialized at completion of measurement.
Note 2: Timer has overflowed.
Figure 1.13.23. Operation timing when measuring a pulse width
84
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Real time Port
Real time Port
When real time port output is selected, the real time port data written to the port Pm register is latched into
the real time port latch each time the corresponding timer Ai underflows, with the data output from each
corresponding port. The real time port data is written to the corresponding port Pm register. When the real
time port mode select bit changes state from “0” to “1”, the value of the real time port latch becomes “0”,
which is output from the corresponding pin. It is when timer Ai underflows first that the real time port data is
output. If the real time port data is modified when the real time port function is enabled, the modified value
is output when timer Ai underflows next time. The port functions as an ordinary port when the real time port
function is disabled.
Make sure timer Ai for real time port output is set for timer mode, and is set to have “no gate function” using
the gate function select bit. Also, before setting the real time port mode select bit to “1”, temporarily turn off
the timer Ai used and write its set value to the timer Ai register. Figure 1.14.1 shows the block diagram for
real time port output. Figure 1.14.2 shows the real time control register.
Pm4 to Pm7 real time
port mode select bit
T Q
Data bus
Port
latch
Pm7
D
f1 f8 f32 fC132 Timer Bj overflow
Pm4 to Pm7 real time port
mode select bit
Timer Ak
overflow
T Q
• Timer mode
Data bus
Timer Ai
Noise
filter
TAiIN
Port
latch
Pm4
D
Timer Ai interrupt
Pm0 to Pm3 real time port
mode select bit
Timer Ai+1
overflow
T Q
Data bus
j=2, k=4, 0, m=0, 1 when i=0, 1
j=5, k=7, 5, m=2, 12 when i=5, 6
Port
latch
Pm0 to Pm3 real time port
mode select bit
Timer Ai mode register's set value used in real time port
T Q
Timer Ai mode register (Addresses 035616, 035716, 039616 and 039716)
b7
b6
b5
b4
0
0
b3
b2
b1
b0
0
0
Pm3
D
Data bus
Port
latch
Pm0
D
Real time port latch
Figure 1.14.1. Block diagram for real time port output
85
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Real time Port
Real time port control register (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
RTP
Address
03FF16
Bit name
Bit symbol
RTP0
RTP1
RTP2
RTP3
When reset
0016
P00 to P03 real time port
mode select bit
P04 to P07 real time port
mode select bit
P10 to P13 real time port
mode select bit
P14 to P17 real time port
mode select bit
RTP4
P20 to P23 real time port
mode select bit
RTP5
P24 to P27 real time port
mode select bit
P120 to P123 real time port
mode select bit
RTP6
R W
Function
The corresponding ports of
output is controlled
0 : Ordinary port output
1 : Real time port output
RTP7
P124 and P125 real time
port mode select bit
Note : The corresponding port direction register is invalidated.
Figure 1.14.2. Real time port control register
Underflow
Counter content (hex)
Underflow
Start count
Time
“1”
Count start flag
“0”
“1”
Timer Ai interrupt
request bit “0”
(i=0, 1, 5, 6)
5516
Real time port output
AA16
Writing to port Pm register
(m=0, 1, 2, 12)
Value to port Pm (example)
5516
AA16
Note : After a reset, the value of the real time port latch is “00”.
The value of the real time port latch changes irrespective of the real time
port mode select bit as the value of the port Pm register is updated by
an underflow of the corresponding timer Ai.
Figure 1.14.3. Timing in real time port output operation
86
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Serial I/O
Serial I/O
Serial I/O is configured as three channels: UART0, UART1, UART2.
UART0 to 2
UART0, UART1 and UART2 each have an exclusive timer to generate a transfer clock, so they operate
independently of each other.
Figure 1.15.1 shows the block diagram of UART0, UART1 and UART2. Figures 1.15.2 and 1.15.3 show
the block diagram of the transmit/receive unit.
UARTi (i = 0 to 2) has two operation modes: a clock synchronous serial I/O mode and a clock asynchronous
serial I/O mode (UART mode). The contents of the serial I/O mode select bits (bits 0 to 2 at addresses
03A016, 03A816 and 037816) determine whether UARTi is used as a clock synchronous serial I/O or as a
UART. Although a few functions are different, UART0, UART1 and UART2 have almost the same functions.
UART2, in particular, is used for the SIM interface with some extra settings added in clock-asynchronous
serial I/O mode (Note). It also has the bus collision detection function that generates an interrupt request if
the TxD pin and the RxD pin are different in level.
Table 1.15.1 shows the comparison of functions of UART0 through UART2, and Figures 1.15.4 to 1.15.8
show the registers related to UARTi.
Note: SIM : Subscriber Identity Module
Table 1.15.1. Comparison of functions of UART0 through UART2
Function
UART0
UART1
UART2
CLK polarity selection
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 1)
LSB first / MSB first selection
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 2)
Continuous receive mode selection
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 1)
Transfer clock output from multiple
pins selection
Impossible
Possible
(Note 1)
Impossible
Serial data logic switch
Impossible
Impossible
Sleep mode selection
Possible
TxD, RxD I/O polarity switch
Impossible
Impossible
Possible
TxD, RxD port output format
CMOS output
CMOS output
N-channel open-drain
output
Parity error signal output
Impossible
Impossible
Possible
Bus collision detection
Impossible
Impossible
Possible
(Note 3)
Possible
Possible
(Note 3)
(Note 4)
Impossible
(Note 4)
Note 1: Only when clock synchronous serial I/O mode.
Note 2: Only when clock synchronous serial I/O mode and 8-bit UART mode.
Note 3: Only when UART mode.
Note 4: Using for SIM interface.
87
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Serial I/O
(UART0)
RxD0
TxD0
UART reception
1/16
Clock source selection
f1
f8
f32
Reception
control circuit
Clock synchronous type
Bit rate generator
Internal (address 03A116)
1 / (n0+1)
UART transmission
1/16
Transmission
control circuit
Clock synchronous type
External
Receive
clock
Transmit/
receive
unit
Transmit
clock
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
1/2
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
Clock synchronous type
(when external clock is
selected)
CLK
polarity
reversing
circuit
CLK0
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS/RTS selected
RTS0
CTS0 / RTS0
Vcc
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS0
(UART1)
RxD1
TxD1
Clock source selection
Bit rate generator
Internal (address 03A916)
f1
f8
f32
UART reception
1/16
1 / (n1+1)
UART transmission
1/16
CTS1 / RTS1/
CLKS1
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
Transmit
clock
Clock synchronous type
(when external clock is
selected)
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS/RTS selected
Clock output pin
select switch
Transmit/
receive
unit
(when internal clock is selected)
1/2
CLK1
Transmission
control circuit
Clock synchronous type
Clock synchronous type
External
CLK
polarity
reversing
circuit
Reception
control circuit
Clock synchronous type
Receive
clock
RTS1
VCC
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS1
(UART2)
TxD
polarity
reversing
circuit
RxD polarity
reversing circuit
RxD2
UART reception
1/16
Clock source selection
Bit rate generator
Internal (address 037916)
f1
f8
f32
1 / (n2+1)
Clock synchronous type
UART transmission
1/16
Clock synchronous type
External
Reception
control circuit
Transmission
control circuit
Receive
clock
Transmit/
receive
unit
Transmit
clock
Clock synchronous type
1/2
CLK2
CLK
polarity
reversing
circuit
(when internal clock is selected)
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
CTS/RTS
selected
Clock synchronous type
(when external clock is
selected)
CTS/RTS disabled
RTS2
CTS2 / RTS2
Vcc
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS2
n0 : Values set to UART0 bit rate generator (BRG0)
n1 : Values set to UART1 bit rate generator (BRG1)
n2 : Values set to UART2 bit rate generator (BRG2)
Figure 1.15.1. Block diagram of UARTi (i = 0 to 2)
88
TxD2
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Serial I/O
Clock
synchronous type
PAR
disabled
1SP
RxDi
SP
SP
UART (7 bits)
UART (8 bits)
Clock
synchronous
type
UARTi receive register
UART (7 bits)
PAR
2SP
PAR
enabled
UART
UART (9 bits)
Clock
synchronous type
UART (8 bits)
UART (9 bits)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
UARTi receive
buffer register
Address 03A616
Address 03A716
Address 03AE16
Address 03AF16
MSB/LSB conversion circuit
Data bus high-order bits
Data bus low-order bits
MSB/LSB conversion circuit
D7
D8
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
UART (9 bits)
2SP
SP
SP
Clock synchronous
type
UART
TxDi
PAR
1SP
UARTi transmit
buffer register
Address 03A216
Address 03A316
Address 03AA16
Address 03AB16
UART (8 bits)
UART (9 bits)
PAR
enabled
D0
PAR
disabled
“0”
Clock
synchronous
type
UART (7 bits)
UARTi transmit register
UART (7 bits)
UART (8 bits)
Clock synchronous
type
SP: Stop bit
PAR: Parity bit
Figure 1.15.2. Block diagram of UARTi (i = 0, 1) transmit/receive unit
89
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Serial I/O
No reverse
RxD data
reverse circuit
RxD2
Reverse
Clock
synchronous type
PAR
disabled
1SP
SP
SP
UART2 receive register
UART(7 bits)
PAR
2SP
PAR
enabled
0
UART
(7 bits)
UART
(8 bits)
Clock
synchronous
type
0
0
0
UART
0
Clock
synchronous type
UART
(9 bits)
0
0
UART
(8 bits)
UART
(9 bits)
D8
D0
UART2 receive
buffer register
Logic reverse circuit + MSB/LSB conversion circuit
Address 037E16
Address 037F16
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
Data bus high-order bits
Data bus low-order bits
Logic reverse circuit + MSB/LSB conversion circuit
D7
D8
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
UART2 transmit
buffer register
Address 037A16
Address 037B16
UART
(8 bits)
UART
(9 bits)
PAR
enabled
2SP
SP
SP
UART
(9 bits)
Clock
synchronous type
UART
PAR
1SP
PAR
disabled
“0”
Clock
synchronous
type
UART
(7 bits)
UART
(8 bits)
UART2 transmit register
UART(7 bits)
Clock
synchronous type
Error signal output
disable
No reverse
TxD data
reverse circuit
Error signal
output circuit
Error signal output
enable
Reverse
SP: Stop bit
PAR: Parity bit
Figure 1.15.3. Block diagram of UART2 transmit/receive unit
90
TxD2
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Serial I/O
UARTi transmit buffer register
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
U0TB
U1TB
U2TB
Address
03A316, 03A216
03AB16, 03AA16
037B16, 037A16
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Function
AA
R W
Transmit data
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turn out to be indeterminate.
UARTi receive buffer register
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Bit
symbol
Symbol
U0RB
U1RB
U2RB
Address
03A716, 03A616
03AF16, 03AE16
037F16, 037E16
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Bit name
Receive data
Function
(During UART mode)
Receive data
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
ABT
Arbitration lost detecting
flag (Note 2)
OER
Overrun error flag (Note 1) 0 : No overrun error
1 : Overrun error found
0 : No overrun error
1 : Overrun error found
FER
Framing error flag (Note 1) Invalid
0 : No framing error
1 : Framing error found
PER
Parity error flag (Note 1)
Invalid
0 : No parity error
1 : Parity error found
SUM
Error sum flag (Note 1)
Invalid
0 : No error
1 : Error found
0 : Not detected
1 : Detected
Invalid
A
AA
AA
AA
A
R W
Note 1: Bits 15 through 12 are set to “0” when the serial I/O mode select bit (bits 2 to 0 at addresses 03A016,
03A816 and 037816) are set to “0002” or the receive enable bit is set to “0”.
(Bit 15 is set to “0” when bits 14 to 12 all are set to “0”.) Bits 14 and 13 are also set to “0” when the
lower byte of the UARTi receive buffer register (addresses 03A616, 03AE16 and 037E16) is read out.
Note 2: Arbitration lost detecting flag is allocated to U2RB and noting but “0” may be written. Nothing is
assigned in bit 11 of U0RB and U1RB. These bits can neither be set or reset. When read, the value
of this bit is “0”.
UARTi bit rate generator
b7
b0
Symbol
U0BRG
U1BRG
U2BRG
Address
03A116
03A916
037916
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Function
Assuming that set value = n, BRGi divides the count source by
n+1
Values that can be set
0016 to FF16
AA
RW
Figure 1.15.4. Serial I/O-related registers (1)
91
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Serial I/O
UARTi transmit/receive mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UiMR(i=0,1)
Address
03A016, 03A816
When reset
0016
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Bit
symbol
Bit name
SMD0
Serial I/O mode select bit
Must be fixed to 001
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid
0 1 0 : Inhibited
0 1 1 : Inhibited
1 1 1 : Inhibited
SMD1
SMD2
Function
(During UART mode)
b2 b1 b0
A
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
A
A
A
A
AA
R W
1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long
1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long
1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long
0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid
0 1 0 : Inhibited
0 1 1 : Inhibited
1 1 1 : Inhibited
CKDIR Internal/external clock
select bit
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note)
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note)
STPS
Stop bit length select bit
Invalid
0 : One stop bit
1 : Two stop bits
PRY
Odd/even parity select bit Invalid
Valid when bit 6 = “1”
0 : Odd parity
1 : Even parity
PRYE
Parity enable bit
Invalid
0 : Parity disabled
1 : Parity enabled
SLEP
Sleep select bit
Must always be “0”
0 : Sleep mode deselected
1 : Sleep mode selected
Note : Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
UART2 transmit/receive mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
U2MR
b0
Address
037816
Bit
symbol
Bit name
SMD0
Serial I/O mode select bit
When reset
0016
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Must be fixed to 001
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid
0 1 0 : (Note 1)
0 1 1 : Inhibited
1 1 1 : Inhibited
SMD1
SMD2
b2 b1 b0
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note 2)
Must always be fixed to “0”
STPS
Stop bit length select bit
Invalid
0 : One stop bit
1 : Two stop bits
PRY
Odd/even parity select bit Invalid
Valid when bit 6 = “1”
0 : Odd parity
1 : Even parity
PRYE
Parity enable bit
Invalid
0 : Parity disabled
1 : Parity enabled
IOPOL
TxD, RxD I/O polarity
reverse bit
0 : No reverse
1 : Reverse
Usually set to “0”
0 : No reverse
1 : Reverse
Usually set to “0”
Figure 1.15.5. Serial I/O-related registers (2)
A
A
A
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
A
A
A
A
AA
1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long
1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long
1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long
0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid
0 1 0 : Inhibited
0 1 1 : Inhibited
1 1 1 : Inhibited
CKDIR Internal/external clock
select bit
Note 1: Bit 2 to bit 0 are set to “0102” when I2C mode is used.
Note 2: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
92
Function
(During UART mode)
R W
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Serial I/O
UARTi transmit/receive control register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UiC0(i=0,1)
Bit
symbol
CLK0
Address
When reset
03A416, 03AC16
0816
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Bit name
b1 b0
BRG count source
select bit
CLK1
CRS
TXEPT
CTS/RTS function
select bit
Function
(During UART mode)
b1 b0
R W
AA
AA
AA
A
AA
AAAA
AA
AA
0 0 : f1 is selected
0 1 : f8 is selected
1 0 : f32 is selected
1 1 : Inhibited
0 0 : f1 is selected
0 1 : f8 is selected
1 0 : f32 is selected
1 1 : Inhibited
Valid when bit 4 = “0”
Valid when bit 4 = “0”
0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1)
1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2)
0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1)
1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2)
0 : Data present in transmit
0 : Data present in transmit register
Transmit register empty
register (during transmission)
(during transmission)
flag
1 : No data present in transmit
1 : No data present in transmit
register (transmission
completed)
register (transmission completed)
CRD
CTS/RTS disable bit
0 : CTS/RTS function enabled
1 : CTS/RTS function disabled
(P60 and P64 function as
programmable I/O port)
0 : CTS/RTS function enabled
1 : CTS/RTS function disabled
(P60 and P64 function as
programmable I/O port)
NCH
Data output select bit
0 : TXDi pin is CMOS output
1 : TXDi pin is N-channel
open-drain output
0: TXDi pin is CMOS output
1: TXDi pin is N-channel
open-drain output
CKPOL
CLK polarity select bit
0 : Transmit data is output at
falling edge of transfer clock
and receive data is input at
rising edge
1 : Transmit data is output at
rising edge of transfer clock
and receive data is input at
falling edge
Must always be “0”
UFORM Transfer format select bit 0 : LSB first
1 : MSB first
Must always be “0”
Note 1: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Note 2: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid.
UART2 transmit/receive control register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U2C0
Bit
symbol
CLK0
Address
037C16
Bit name
BRG count source
select bit
CLK1
CRS
TXEPT
CTS/RTS function
select bit
When reset
0816
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
b1 b0
b1 b0
0 0 : f1 is selected
0 1 : f8 is selected
1 0 : f32 is selected
1 1 : Inhibited
Valid when bit 4 = “0”
Valid when bit 4 = “0”
0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1)
1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2)
0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1)
1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2)
0 : Data present in transmit
0 : Data present in transmit register
Transmit register empty
register (during transmission)
(during transmission)
flag
1 : No data present in transmit
1 : No data present in transmit
CTS/RTS disable bit
Nothing is assigned.
register (transmission completed)
0 : CTS/RTS function enabled
1 : CTS/RTS function disabled
(P73 functions
programmable I/O port)
0 : CTS/RTS function enabled
1 : CTS/RTS function disabled
(P73 functions programmable
I/O port)
0 : TXDi pin is CMOS output
0: TXDi pin is CMOS output
: TXDi
pinvalue,
is N-channel
1: TXDi
is N-channel
In an attempt to write to this bit, write1“0”.
The
if read, turns out
to bepin“0”.
CKPOL
AA
AAAA
AA
AA
AAAA
R W
0 0 : f1 is selected
0 1 : f8 is selected
1 0 : f32 is selected
1 1 : Inhibited
register (transmission
completed)
CRD
Function
(During UART mode)
CLK polarity select bit
open-drain output
0 : Transmit data is output at
falling edge of transfer clock
and receive data is input at
rising edge
1 : Transmit data is output at
rising edge of transfer clock
and receive data is input at
falling edge
UFORM Transfer format select bit 0 : LSB first
1 : MSB first
(Note 3)
open-drain output
Must always be “0”
0 : LSB first
1 : MSB first
AAAA
AAAA
Note 1: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Note 2: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid.
Note 3: Only clock synchronous serial I/O mode and 8-bit UART mode are valid.
Figure 1.15.6. Serial I/O-related registers (3)
93
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Serial I/O
UARTi transmit/receive control register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
UiC1(i=0,1)
b0
Bit
symbol
Address
03A516,03AD16
When reset
0216
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Bit name
Function
(During UART mode)
TE
Transmit enable bit
0 : Transmission disabled
1 : Transmission enabled
0 : Transmission disabled
1 : Transmission enabled
TI
Transmit buffer
empty flag
0 : Data present in
transmit buffer register
1 : No data present in
transmit buffer register
0 : Data present in
transmit buffer register
1 : No data present in
transmit buffer register
RE
Receive enable bit
0 : Reception disabled
1 : Reception enabled
0 : Reception disabled
1 : Reception enabled
RI
Receive complete flag
0 : No data present in
receive buffer register
1 : Data present in
receive buffer register
0 : No data present in
receive buffer register
1 : Data present in
receive buffer register
R W
A
A
A
A
A
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
UART2 transmit/receive control register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
U2C1
b0
Bit
symbol
Address
037D16
Bit name
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Function
(During UART mode)
TE
Transmit enable bit
0 : Transmission disabled
1 : Transmission enabled
0 : Transmission disabled
1 : Transmission enabled
TI
Transmit buffer
empty flag
0 : Data present in
transmit buffer register
1 : No data present in
transmit buffer register
0 : Data present in
transmit buffer register
1 : No data present in
transmit buffer register
RE
Receive enable bit
0 : Reception disabled
1 : Reception enabled
0 : Reception disabled
1 : Reception enabled
RI
Receive complete flag
0 : No data present in
receive buffer register
1 : Data present in
receive buffer register
0 : No data present in
receive buffer register
1 : Data present in
receive buffer register
0 : Transmit buffer empty
(TI = 1)
1 : Transmit is completed
(TXEPT = 1)
0 : Transmit buffer empty
(TI = 1)
1 : Transmit is completed
(TXEPT = 1)
U2RRM UART2 continuous
receive mode enable bit
0 : Continuous receive
mode disabled
1 : Continuous receive
mode enabled
Invalid
U2LCH Data logic select bit
0 : No reverse
1 : Reverse
0 : No reverse
1 : Reverse
U2ERE Error signal output
enable bit
Must be fixed to “0”
0 : Output disabled
1 : Output enabled
U2IRS UART2 transmit interrupt
cause select bit
Figure 1.15.7. Serial I/O-related registers (4)
94
When reset
0216
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
R W
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Serial I/O
UART transmit/receive control register 2
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UCON
0
Bit
symbol
U0IRS
Address
03B016
When reset
X00000002
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Bit
name
UART0 transmit
interrupt cause select bit
0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1)
1 : Transmission completed
(TXEPT = 1)
U1IRS
0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1)
1 : Transmission completed
UART1 transmit
interrupt cause select bit
(TXEPT = 1)
Function
(During UART mode)
0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1)
1 : Transmission completed
(TXEPT = 1)
0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1)
1 : Transmission completed
(TXEPT = 1)
U0RRM UART0 continuous
receive mode enable bit
0 : Continuous receive
mode disabled
1 : Continuous receive
mode enable
Invalid
U1RRM UART1 continuous
receive mode enable bit
0 : Continuous receive
mode disabled
1 : Continuous receive
mode enabled
Invalid
CLKMD0 CLK/CLKS select bit 0
Valid when bit 5 = “1”
0 : Clock output to CLK1
1 : Clock output to CLKS1
Invalid
CLKMD1 CLK/CLKS select
bit 1 (Note)
0 : Normal mode
Must always be “0”
(CLK output is CLK1 only)
1 : Transfer clock output
from multiple pins
function selected
Always set to “0”
Reserved bit
A
A
A
A
AA
A
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
RW
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate.
Note: When using multiple pins to output the transfer clock, the following requirements must be met:
• UART1 internal/external clock select bit (bit 3 at address 03A816) = “0”.
UART2 special mode register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
U2SMR
0
Bit
symbol
Address
037716
Bit
name
When reset
0016
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Function
(During UART mode)
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
A
IICM
IIC mode selection bit
0 : Normal mode
1 : IIC mode
Must always be “0”
ABC
Arbitration lost detecting
flag control bit
0 : Update per bit
1 : Update per byte
Must always be “0”
BBS
Bus busy flag
0 : STOP condition detected
1 : START condition detected
Must always be “0”
SCLL sync output
enable bit
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
Must always be “0”
ABSCS
Bus collision detect
sampling
clock select bit
Must always be “0”
0 : Rising edge of transfer
clock
1 : Underflow signal of timer A0
ACSE
Auto clear function
select bit of transmit
enable bit
Must always be “0”
0 : No auto clear function
1 : Auto clear at occurrence of
bus collision
SSS
Transmit start condition
select bit
Must always be “0”
0 : Ordinary
1 : Falling edge of RxD2
LSYN
Reserved bit
Note: Nothing but "0" may be written.
Always set to “0”
R W
(Note)
Figure 1.15.8. Serial I/O-related registers (5)
95
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
(1) Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
The clock synchronous serial I/O mode uses a transfer clock to transmit and receive data. Tables 1.15.2
and 1.15.3 list the specifications of the clock synchronous serial I/O mode. Figure 1.15.9 shows the
UARTi transmit/receive mode register.
Table 1.15.2. Specifications of clock synchronous serial I/O mode (1)
Item
Transfer data format
Transfer clock
Specification
• Transfer data length: 8 bits
• When internal clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816, 037816
= “0”) : fi/ 2(n+1) (Note 1) fi = f1, f8, f32
• When external clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816, 037816
= “1”) : Input from CLKi pin
_______
_______
_______ _______
Transmission/reception control • CTS function/RTS function/CTS, RTS function chosen to be invalid
Transmission start condition • To start transmission, the following requirements must be met:
_ Transmit enable bit (bit 0 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1”
_ Transmit buffer empty flag (bit 1 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “0”
_______
_______
_ When CTS function selected, CTS input level = “L”
• Furthermore, if external clock is selected, the following requirements must also be met:
_ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”:
CLKi input level = “H”
_ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”:
CLKi input level = “L”
Reception start condition • To start reception, the following requirements must be met:
_ Receive enable bit (bit 2 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1”
_ Transmit enable bit (bit 0 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1”
_ Transmit buffer empty flag (bit 1 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “0”
• Furthermore, if external clock is selected, the following requirements must
also be met:
_ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”:
CLKi input level = “H”
_ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”:
CLKi input level = “L”
• When transmitting
Interrupt request
_ Transmit interrupt cause select bit (bits 0, 1 at address 03B016, bit 4 at
generation timing
address 037D16) = “0”: Interrupts requested when data transfer from UARTi
transfer buffer register to UARTi transmit register is completed
_ Transmit interrupt cause select bit (bits 0, 1 at address 03B016, bit 4 at
address 037D16) = “1”: Interrupts requested when data transmission from
UARTi transfer register is completed
• When receiving
_ Interrupts requested when data transfer from UARTi receive register to
UARTi receive buffer register is completed
Error detection
• Overrun error (Note 2)
This error occurs when the next data is ready before contents of UARTi
receive buffer register are read out
Note 1: “n” denotes the value 0016 to FF16 that is set to the UART bit rate generator.
Note 2: If an overrun error occurs, the UARTi receive buffer will have the next data written in. Note also that
the UARTi receive interrupt request bit is not set to “1”.
96
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Table 1.15.3. Specifications of clock synchronous serial I/O mode (2)
Item
Select function
Specification
• CLK polarity selection
Whether transmit data is output/input at the rising edge or falling edge of the
transfer clock can be selected
• LSB first/MSB first selection
Whether transmission/reception begins with bit 0 or bit 7 can be selected
• Continuous receive mode selection
Reception is enabled simultaneously by a read from the receive buffer register
• Transfer clock output from multiple pins selection (UART1)
UART1 transfer clock can be chosen by software to be output from one of
the two pins set
• Switching serial data logic (UART2)
Whether to reverse data in writing to the transmission buffer register or
reading the reception buffer register can be selected.
• TxD, RxD I/O polarity reverse (UART2)
This function is reversing TxD port output and RxD port input. All I/O data
level is reversed.
97
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
UARTi transmit/receive mode registers
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
0
b2
b1
b0
0 0 1
Symbol
UiMR(i=0,1)
Bit symbol
SMD0
Address
03A016, 03A816
When reset
0016
Bit name
Serial I/O mode select bit
SMD1
SMD2
Internal/external clock
select bit
CKDIR
Function
b2 b1 b0
0 0 1 : Clock synchronous serial
I/O mode
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note)
STPS
PRY
Invalid in clock synchronous serial I/O mode
PRYE
SLEP
0 (Must always be “0” in clock synchronous serial I/O mode)
Note : Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
A
A
A
A
A
RW
UART2 transmit/receive mode register
b7
0
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0 1
Symbol
U2MR
Bit symbol
SMD0
Address
037816
Bit name
Serial I/O mode select bit
SMD1
SMD2
CKDIR
When reset
0016
Internal/external clock
select bit
Function
b2 b1 b0
0 0 1 : Clock synchronous serial
I/O mode
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note2)
STPS
PRY
Invalid in clock synchronous serial I/O mode
PRYE
IOPOL
TxD, RxD I/O polarity
reverse bit (Note1)
0 : No reverse
1 : Reverse
Note1 : Usually set to “0”.
Note2 : Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
A
A
A
A
A
A
RW
Figure 1.15.9. UARTi transmit/receive mode register in clock synchronous serial I/O mode
98
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Table 1.15.4 lists the functions of the input/output pins during clock synchronous serial I/O mode. This
table shows the pin functions when the transfer clock output from multiple pins function is not selected.
Note that for a period from when the UARTi operation mode is selected to when transfer starts, the TxDi
pin outputs a “H”. (If the N-channel open-drain is selected, this pin is in floating state.)
Table 1.15.4. Input/output pin functions in clock synchronous serial I/O mode
(when transfer clock output from multiple pins is not selected)
Pin name
Function
Method of selection
TxDi
Serial data output
(P63, P67, P70)
(Outputs dummy data when performing reception only)
Serial data input
RxDi
(P62, P66, P71)
Port P62, P66 and P71 direction register (bits 2 and 6 at address 03EE16,
bit 1 at address 03EF16)= “0”
(Can be used as an input port when performing transmission only)
CLKi
Transfer clock output
(P61, P65, P72)
Transfer clock input
Internal/external clock select bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816, 037816) = “0”
CTSi/RTSi
CTS input
(P60, P64, P73)
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) =“0”
CTS/RTS function select bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”
Port P60, P64 and P73 direction register (bits 0 and 4 at address 03EE16,
bit 3 at address 03EF16) = “0”
Internal/external clock select bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816, 037816) = “1”
Port P61, P65 and P72 direction register (bits 1 and 5 at address 03EE16,
bit 2 at address 03EF16) = “0”
RTS output
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”
CTS/RTS function select bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”
Programmable I/O port
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”
99
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
• Example of transmit timing (when internal clock is selected)
Tc
Transfer clock
Transmit enable
bit (TE)
Transmit buffer
empty flag (Tl)
“1”
“0”
Data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register
“1”
“0”
Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register
“H”
CTSi
TCLK
“L”
Stopped pulsing because CTS = “H”
Stopped pulsing because transfer enable bit = “0”
CLKi
TxDi
D0 D 1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D 6 D7
Transmit
register empty
flag (TXEPT)
D0 D1 D 2 D3 D 4 D 5 D 6 D 7
D0 D1 D 2 D 3 D 4 D5 D6 D7
“1”
“0”
Transmit interrupt “1”
request bit (IR)
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings:
• Internal clock is selected.
• CTS function is selected.
• CLK polarity select bit = “0”.
• Transmit interrupt cause select bit = “0”.
Tc = TCLK = 2(n + 1) / fi
fi: frequency of BRGi count source (f1, f8, f32)
n: value set to BRGi
• Example of receive timing (when external clock is selected)
“1”
Receive enable
bit (RE)
“0”
Transmit enable
bit (TE)
“0”
Transmit buffer
empty flag (Tl)
“1”
“0”
“H”
RTSi
Dummy data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register
“1”
Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register
“L”
1 / fEXT
CLKi
Receive data is taken in
D0 D 1 D 2 D3 D 4 D 5 D6 D 7
RxDi
Receive complete “1”
flag (Rl)
“0”
Receive interrupt
request bit (IR)
Transferred from UARTi receive register
to UARTi receive buffer register
D0 D1 D2
D 3 D4 D 5
Read out from UARTi receive buffer register
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings:
• External clock is selected.
• RTS function is selected.
• CLK polarity select bit = “0”.
Meet the following conditions are met when the CLK
input before data reception = “H”
• Transmit enable bit “1”
• Receive enable bit “1”
• Dummy data write to UARTi transmit buffer register
fEXT: frequency of external clock
Figure 1.15.10. Typical transmit/receive timings in clock synchronous serial I/O mode
100
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
(a) Polarity select function
As shown in Figure 1.15.11, the CLK polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16)
allows selection of the polarity of the transfer clock.
• When CLK polarity select bit = “0”
CLKi
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
R XD i
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Note 1: The CLK pin level when not
transferring data is “H”.
• When CLK polarity select bit = “1”
CLKi
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
R XD i
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Note 2: The CLK pin level when not
transferring data is “L”.
Figure 1.15.11. Polarity of transfer clock
(b) LSB first/MSB first select function
As shown in Figure 1.15.12, when the transfer format select bit (bit 7 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16,
037C16) = “0”, the transfer format is “LSB first”; when the bit = “1”, the transfer format is “MSB first”.
• When transfer format select bit = “0”
CLKi
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
LSB first
R XD i
• When transfer format select bit = “1”
CLKi
TXDi
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
MSB first
R XD i
Note: This applies when the CLK polarity select bit = “0”.
Figure 1.15.12. Transfer format
101
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
(c) Transfer clock output from multiple pins function (UART1)
This function allows the setting two transfer clock output pins and choosing one of the two to output a
clock by using the CLK and CLKS select bit (bits 4 and 5 at address 03B016). (See Figure 1.15.3.)
The multiple pins function is valid only when the internal clock is selected for UART1. Note that when
_______ _______
this function is selected, UART1 CTS/RTS function cannot be used.
Microcomputer
TXD1 (P67)
CLKS1 (P64)
CLK1 (P65)
IN
IN
CLK
CLK
Note: This applies when the internal clock is selected and transmission
is performed only in clock synchronous serial I/O mode.
Figure 1.15.13. The transfer clock output from the multiple pins function usage
(d) Continuous receive mode
If the continuous receive mode enable bit (bits 2 and 3 at address 03B016, bit 5 at address 037D16) is
set to “1”, the unit is placed in continuous receive mode. In this mode, when the receive buffer register
is read out, the unit simultaneously goes to a receive enable state without having to set dummy data to
the transmit buffer register back again.
(e) Serial data logic switch function (UART2)
When the data logic select bit (bit6 at address 037D16) = “1”, and writing to transmit buffer register or
reading from receive buffer register, data is reversed. Figure 1.15.14 shows the example of serial data
logic switch timing.
•When LSB first
Transfer clock
“H”
“L”
TxD2
“H”
(no reverse) “L”
TxD2
“H”
(reverse) “L”
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Figure 1.15.14. Serial data logic switch timing
102
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
(2) Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
The UART mode allows transmitting and receiving data after setting the desired transfer rate and transfer
data format. Tables 1.15.5 and 1.15.6 list the specifications of the UART mode. Figure 1.15.15 shows
the UARTi transmit/receive mode register.
Table 1.15.5. Specifications of UART Mode (1)
Item
Transfer data format
Transfer clock
Specification
• Character bit (transfer data): 7 bits, 8 bits, or 9 bits as selected
• Start bit: 1 bit
• Parity bit: Odd, even, or nothing as selected
• Stop bit: 1 bit or 2 bits as selected
• When internal clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816, 037816 = “0”) :
fi/16(n+1) (Note 1) fi = f1, f8, f32
• When external clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816 =“1”) :
fEXT/16(n+1) (Note 1) (Note 2) (Do not set external clock for UART2)
_______
_______
_______
_______
Transmission/reception control • CTS function/RTS function/CTS, RTS function chosen to be invalid
Transmission start condition • To start transmission, the following requirements must be met:
- Transmit enable bit (bit 0 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1”
- Transmit buffer empty flag (bit 1 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “0”
_______
_______
- When CTS function selected, CTS input level = “L”
Reception start condition • To start reception, the following requirements must be met:
- Receive enable bit (bit 2 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1”
- Start bit detection
Interrupt request
• When transmitting
generation timing
- Transmit interrupt cause select bits (bits 0,1 at address 03B016, bit4 at
address 037D16) = “0”: Interrupts requested when data transfer from UARTi
transfer buffer register to UARTi transmit register is completed
- Transmit interrupt cause select bits (bits 0, 1 at address 03B016, bit4 at
address 037D16) = “1”: Interrupts requested when data transmission from
UARTi transfer register is completed
• When receiving
- Interrupts requested when data transfer from UARTi receive register to
UARTi receive buffer register is completed
Error detection
• Overrun error (Note 3)
This error occurs when the next data is ready before contents of UARTi
receive buffer register are read out
• Framing error
This error occurs when the number of stop bits set is not detected
• Parity error
This error occurs when if parity is enabled, the number of 1’s in parity and
character bits does not match the number of 1’s set
• Error sum flag
This flag is set (= 1) when any of the overrun, framing, and parity errors is
encountered
Note 1: ‘n’ denotes the value 0016 to FF16 that is set to the UARTi bit rate generator.
Note 2: fEXT is input from the CLKi pin.
Note 3: If an overrun error occurs, the UARTi receive buffer will have the next data written in. Note also that
the UARTi receive interrupt request bit is not set to “1”.
103
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Table 1.15.6. Specifications of UART Mode (2)
Item
Select function
104
Specification
• Sleep mode selection (UART0, UART1)
This mode is used to transfer data to and from one of multiple slave microcomputers
• Serial data logic switch (UART2)
This function is reversing logic value of transferring data. Start bit, parity bit
and stop bit are not reversed.
• TXD, RXD I/O polarity switch (UART2)
This function is reversing TXD port output and RXD port input. All I/O data
level is reversed.
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
UARTi transmit / receive mode registers
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UiMR(i=0,1)
Bit symbol
SMD0
Address
03A016, 03A816
Bit name
Serial I/O mode select bit
SMD1
SMD2
CKDIR
When reset
0016
Function
b2 b1 b0
1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long
1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long
1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long
Internal / external clock
select bit
Stop bit length select bit
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note)
0 : One stop bit
1 : Two stop bits
PRY
Odd / even parity
select bit
Valid when bit 6 = “1”
0 : Odd parity
1 : Even parity
PRYE
Parity enable bit
0 : Parity disabled
1 : Parity enabled
SLEP
Sleep select bit
0 : Sleep mode deselected
1 : Sleep mode selected
STPS
Note : Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
AA
AA
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
A
AA
RW
UART2 transmit / receive mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U2MR
Bit symbol
SMD0
Address
037816
Bit name
Serial I/O mode select bit
SMD1
SMD2
CKDIR
STPS
When reset
0016
Internal / external clock
select bit
Stop bit length select bit
Function
b2 b1 b0
1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long
1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long
1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long
Must always be fixed to “0”
0 : One stop bit
1 : Two stop bits
PRY
Odd / even parity
select bit
Valid when bit 6 = “1”
0 : Odd parity
1 : Even parity
PRYE
Parity enable bit
0 : Parity disabled
1 : Parity enabled
IOPOL
TxD, RxD I/O polarity
reverse bit (Note)
0 : No reverse
1 : Reverse
Note : Usually set to “0”.
AA
A
A
AA
A
A
AA
A
A
A
A
A
A
AA
RW
Figure 1.15.15. UARTi transmit/receive mode register in UART mode
105
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Table 1.15.7 lists the functions of the input/output pins during UART mode. Note that for a period from
when the UARTi operation mode is selected to when transfer starts, the TxDi pin outputs a “H”. (If the Nchannel open-drain is selected, this pin is in floating state.)
Table 1.15.7. Input/output pin functions in UART mode
Pin name
Function
TxDi
Serial data output
(P63, P67, P70)
Method of selection
RxDi
Serial data input
(P62, P66, P71)
Port P62, P66 and P71 direction register (bits 2 and 6 at address 03EE16,
bit 1 at address 03EF16)= “0”
(Can be used as an input port when performing transmission only)
CLKi
Programmable I/O port
(P61, P65, P72)
Transfer clock input
Internal/external clock select bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816, 037816) = “0”
CTSi/RTSi
CTS input
(P60, P64, P73)
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) =“0”
CTS/RTS function select bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”
Port P60, P64 and P73 direction register (bits 0 and 4 at address 03EE16,
bit 3 at address 03EF16) = “0”
106
Internal/external clock select bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816) = “1”
Port P61, P65 direction register (bits 1 and 5 at address 03EE16) = “0”
(Do not set external clock for UART2)
RTS output
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”
CTS/RTS function select bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”
Programmable I/O port
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
• Example of transmit timing when transfer data is 8 bits long (parity enabled, one stop bit)
The transfer clock stops momentarily as CTS is “H” when the stop bit is checked.
The transfer clock starts as the transfer starts immediately CTS changes to “L”.
Tc
Transfer clock
Transmit enable
bit(TE)
“1”
Transmit buffer
empty flag(TI)
“1”
“0”
Data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register.
“0”
Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register
“H”
CTSi
“L”
Start
bit
TxDi
Parity
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
Stopped pulsing because transmit enable bit = “0”
Stop
bit
SP
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
ST D0 D1
SP
“1”
Transmit register
empty flag (TXEPT)
“0”
Transmit interrupt
request bit (IR)
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings :
• Parity is enabled.
• One stop bit.
• CTS function is selected.
• Transmit interrupt cause select bit = “1”.
Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT
fi : frequency of BRGi count source (f1, f8, f32)
fEXT : frequency of BRGi count source (external clock)
n : value set to BRGi
• Example of transmit timing when transfer data is 9 bits long (parity disabled, two stop bits)
Tc
Transfer clock
Transmit enable
bit(TE)
“1”
Transmit buffer
empty flag(TI)
“1”
“0”
Data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register
“0”
Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register
Start
bit
TxDi
Stop
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SP SP
Stop
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SPSP
ST D0 D1
“1”
Transmit register
empty flag (TXEPT)
“0”
Transmit interrupt
request bit (IR)
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings :
• Parity is disabled.
• Two stop bits.
• CTS function is disabled.
• Transmit interrupt cause select bit = “0”.
Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT
fi : frequency of BRGi count source (f1, f8, f32)
fEXT : frequency of BRGi count source (external clock)
n : value set to BRGi
Figure 1.15.16. Typical transmit timings in UART mode(UART0,UART1)
107
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
• Example of transmit timing when transfer data is 8 bits long (parity enabled, one stop bit)
Tc
Transfer clock
Transmit enable
bit(TE)
“1”
Transmit buffer
empty flag(TI)
“1”
Data is set in UART2 transmit buffer register
“0”
Note
“0”
Transferred from UART2 transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register
Parity
bit
Start
bit
TxD2
ST D0 D1
D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
Stop
bit
SP
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
SP
“1”
Transmit register
empty flag (TXEPT) “0”
Transmit interrupt
request bit (IR)
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings :
• Parity is enabled.
• One stop bit.
• Transmit interrupt cause select bit = “1”.
Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi
fi : frequency of BRG2 count source (f1, f8, f32)
n : value set to BRG2
Note: The transmit is started with overflow timing of BRG after having written in a value at the transmit buffer in the above timing.
Figure 1.15.17. Typical transmit timings in UART mode(UART2)
108
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
• Example of receive timing when transfer data is 8 bits long (parity disabled, one stop bit)
BRGi count
source
Receive enable bit
“1”
“0”
Stop bit
Start bit
RxDi
D1
D0
D7
Sampled “L”
Receive data taken in
Transfer clock
Receive
complete flag
RTSi
Receive interrupt
request bit
“1”
Reception triggered when transfer clock
is generated by falling edge of start bit
Transferred from UARTi receive register to
UARTi receive buffer register
“0”
“H”
“L”
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
The above timing applies to the following settings :
•Parity is disabled.
•One stop bit.
•RTS function is selected.
Figure 1.15.18. Typical receive timing in UART mode
(a) Sleep mode (UART0, UART1)
This mode is used to transfer data between specific microcomputers among multiple microcomputers
connected using UARTi. The sleep mode is selected when the sleep select bit (bit 7 at addresses
03A016, 03A816) is set to “1” during reception. In this mode, the unit performs receive operation when
the MSB of the received data = “1” and does not perform receive operation when the MSB = “0”.
109
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
(b) Function for switching serial data logic (UART2)
When the data logic select bit (bit 6 of address 037D16) is assigned 1, data is inverted in writing to the
transmission buffer register or reading the reception buffer register. Figure 1.15.19 shows the example of timing for switching serial data logic.
• When LSB first, parity enabled, one stop bit
Transfer clock
“H”
“L”
TxD2
“H”
(no reverse)
“L”
TxD2
“H”
(reverse)
“L”
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
ST : Start bit
P : Even parity
SP : Stop bit
Figure 1.15.19. Timing for switching serial data logic
(c) TxD, RxD I/O polarity reverse function (UART2)
This function is to reverse TXD pin output and RXD pin input. The level of any data to be input or output
(including the start bit, stop bit(s), and parity bit) is reversed. Set this function to “0” (not to reverse) for
usual use.
(d) Bus collision detection function (UART2)
This function is to sample the output level of the TXD pin and the input level of the RXD pin at the rising
edge of the transfer clock; if their values are different, then an interrupt request occurs. Figure 1.15.20
shows the example of detection timing of a buss collision (in UART mode).
Transfer clock
“H”
“L”
TxD2
“H”
ST
SP
ST
SP
“L”
RxD2
“H”
“L”
Bus collision detection
interrupt request signal
“1”
Bus collision detection
interrupt request bit
“1”
“0”
“0”
ST : Start bit
SP : Stop bit
Figure 1.15.20. Detection timing of a bus collision (in UART mode)
110
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
(3) Clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode (compliant with the SIM interface)
The SIM interface is used for connecting the microcomputer with a memory card or the like; adding some
extra settings in UART2 clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode allows the user to effect this function. Table
1.15.8 shows the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode (compliant with the SIM interface).
Table 1.15.8. Specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode (compliant with the SIM interface)
Item
Transfer data format
Transfer clock
Specification
• Transfer data 8-bit UART mode (bit 2 through bit 0 of address 037816 = “1012”)
• One stop bit (bit 4 of address 037816 = “0”)
• With the direct format chosen
Set parity to “even” (bit 5 and bit 6 of address 037816 = “1” and “1” respectively)
Set data logic to “direct” (bit 6 of address 037D16 = “0”).
Set transfer format to LSB (bit 7 of address 037C16 = “0”).
• With the inverse format chosen
Set parity to “odd” (bit 5 and bit 6 of address 037816 = “0” and “1” respectively)
Set data logic to “inverse” (bit 6 of address 037D16 = “1”)
Set transfer format to MSB (bit 7 of address 037C16 = “1”)
• With the internal clock chosen (bit 3 of address 037816 = “0”) : fi / 16 (n + 1) (Note 1) : fi=f1, f8, f32
(Do not set external clock)
_______
_______
Transmission / reception control • Disable the CTS and RTS function (bit 4 of address 037C16 = “1”)
Other settings
• The sleep mode select function is not available for UART2
• Set transmission interrupt factor to “transmission completed” (bit 4 of address 037D16 = “1”)
Transmission start condition • To start transmission, the following requirements must be met:
- Transmit enable bit (bit 0 of address 037D16) = “1”
- Transmit buffer empty flag (bit 1 of address 037D16) = “0”
Reception start condition
• To start reception, the following requirements must be met:
- Reception enable bit (bit 2 of address 037D16) = “1”
- Detection of a start bit
Interrupt request
• When transmitting
generation timing
When data transmission from the UART2 transfer register is completed
(bit 4 of address 037D16 = “1”)
• When receiving
When data transfer from the UART2 receive register to the UART2 receive
buffer register is completed
Error detection
• Overrun error (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O) (Note 2)
• Framing error (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O)
• Parity error (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O)
- On the reception side, an “L” level is output from the TXD2 pin by use of the parity error
signal output function (bit 7 of address 037D16 = “1”) when a parity error is detected
- On the transmission side, a parity error is detected by the level of input to
the RXD2 pin when a transmission interrupt occurs
• The error sum flag (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O)
Note 1: ‘n’ denotes the value 0016 to FF16 that is set to the UARTi bit rate generator.
Note 2: If an overrun error occurs, the UART2 receive buffer will have the next data written in. Note also
that the UARTi receive interrupt request bit is not set to “1”.
111
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
Tc
Transfer clock
Transmit enable
bit(TE)
“1”
Transmit buffer
empty flag(TI)
“1”
“0”
Data is set in UART2 transmit buffer register
Note 1
“0”
Transferred from UART2 transmit buffer register to UART2 transmit register
Start
bit
TxD2
Parity
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
Stop
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
SP
P
SP
P
SP
RxD2
A “L” level returns from TxD2 due to
the occurrence of a parity error.
Signal conductor level
(Note 2)
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
SP
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
The level is
detected by the
interrupt routine.
The level is detected by the
interrupt routine.
“1”
Transmit register
empty flag (TXEPT)
“0”
Transmit interrupt
request bit (IR)
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings :
• Parity is enabled.
• One stop bit.
• Transmit interrupt cause select bit = “1”.
Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi
fi : frequency of BRG2 count source (f1, f8, f32)
n : value set to BRG2
Tc
Transfer clock
Receive enable
bit (RE)
“1”
“0”
Start
bit
RxD2
Parity
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
Stop
bit
SP
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
SP
TxD2
A “L” level returns from TxD2 due to
the occurrence of a parity error.
Signal conductor level
(Note 2)
Receive complete
flag (RI)
“1”
Receive interrupt
request bit (IR)
“1”
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
SP
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
SP
“0”
Read to receive buffer
Read to receive buffer
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings :
• Parity is enabled.
• One stop bit.
• Transmit interrupt cause select bit = “0”.
Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi
fi : frequency of BRG2 count source (f1, f8, f32)
n : value set to BRG2
Note 1 : The transmit is started with overflow timing of BRG after having written in a value at the transmit buffer in the above timing.
Note 2 : Equal in waveform because TxD2 and RxD2 are connected.
Figure 1.15.21. Typical transmit/receive timing in UART mode (compliant with the SIM interface)
112
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
(a) Function for outputting a parity error signal
With the error signal output enable bit (bit 7 of address 037D16) assigned “1”, you can output an “L”
level from the TxD2 pin when a parity error is detected. In step with this function, the generation timing
of a transmission completion interrupt changes to the detection timing of a parity error signal. Figure
1.15.22 shows the output timing of the parity error signal.
• LSB first
Transfer
clock
“H”
RxD2
“H”
TxD2
“H”
Receive
complete flag
“1”
“L”
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
“L”
Hi-Z
“L”
“0”
ST : Start bit
P : Even Parity
SP : Stop bit
Figure 1.15.22. Output timing of the parity error signal
(b) Direct format/inverse format
Connecting the SIM card allows you to switch between direct format and inverse format. If you choose
the direct format, D0 data is output from TxD2. If you choose the inverse format, D7 data is inverted
and output from TxD2.
Figure 1.15.23 shows the SIM interface format.
Transfer
clcck
TxD2
(direct)
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
TxD2
(inverse)
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
P
P : Even parity
Figure 1.15.23. SIM interface format
113
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Figure 1.15.24 shows the example of connecting the SIM interface. Connect TXD2 and RXD2 and apply
pull-up.
Microcomputer
SIM card
TxD2
RxD2
Figure 1.15.24. Connecting the SIM interface
114
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
UART2 Special Mode Register
UART2 Special Mode Register
The UART2 special mode register (address 037716) is used to control UART2 in various ways.
Figure 1.15.25 shows the UART2 special mode register.
UART2 special mode register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
U2SMR
0
Bit
symbol
Address
037716
When reset
0016
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Bit name
Function
(During UART mode)
AAA
A
AAAAA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
IICM
I 2C mode selection bit
0 : Normal mode
1 : I2 C mode
Must always be “0”
ABC
Arbitration lost detecting
flag control bit
0 : Update per bit
1 : Update per byte
Must always be “0”
BBS
Bus busy flag
0 : STOP condition detected
1 : START condition detected
Must always be “0”
LSYN
SCLL sync output
enable bit
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
Must always be “0”
ABSCS
Bus collision detect
sampling clock select bit
Must always be “0”
0 : Rising edge of transfer
clock
1 : Underflow signal of timer A0
ACSE
Auto clear function
select bit of transmit
enable bit
Must always be “0”
0 : No auto clear function
1 : Auto clear at occurrence of
bus collision
Transmit start condition
select bit
Must always be “0”
0 : Ordinary
1 : Falling edge of RxD2
SSS
Reserved bit
R W
(Note)
Always set to “0”
Note: Nothing but "0" may be written.
Figure 1.15.25. UART2 special mode register
Table 1.15.9. Features in I2C mode
Function
Normal mode
I2C mode (Note 1)
Start condition detection or stop
condition detection
1
Factor of interrupt number 10 (Note 2)
Bus collision detection
2
Factor of interrupt number 15 (Note 2)
UART2 transmission
No acknowledgment detection (NACK)
3
Factor of interrupt number 16 (Note 2)
UART2 reception
Acknowledgment detection (ACK)
4
UART2 transmission output delay
Not delayed
Delayed
5
P70 at the time when UART2 is in use
TxD2 (output)
SDA (input/output) (Note 3)
6
P71 at the time when UART2 is in use
RxD2 (input)
SCL (input/output)
7
P72 at the time when UART2 is in use
CLK2
P72
8
DMA1 factor at the time when 1 1 0 1 is assigned
to the DMA request factor selection bits
UART2 reception
Acknowledgment detection (ACK)
9
Noise filter width
15ns
50ns
10 Reading P71
Reading the terminal when 0 is
assigned to the direction register
Reading the terminal regardless of the
value of the direction register
11 Initial value of UART2 output
H level (when 0 is assigned to
the CLK polarity select bit)
The value set in latch P70 when the port is
selected
Note 1: Make the settings given below when I2C mode is in use.
Set 0 1 0 in bits 2, 1, 0 of the UART2 transmission/reception mode register.
Disable the RTS/CTS function. Choose the MSB First function.
Note 2: Follow the steps given below to switch from a factor to another.
1. Disable the interrupt of the corresponding number.
2. Switch from a factor to another.
3. Reset the interrupt request flag of the corresponding number.
4. Set an interrupt level of the corresponding number.
Note 3: Set an initial value of SDA transmission output when serial I/O is invalid.
115
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
UART2 Special Mode Register
In the first place, the control bits related to the I2C bus (simplified I2C bus) interface are explained.
Bit 0 of the UART special mode register (037716) is used as the I2C mode selection bit.
Setting “1” in the I2C mode select bit (bit 0) goes the circuit to achieve the I2C bus (simplified I2C bus)
interface effective.
Table 1.15.9 shows the relation between the I2C mode select bit and respective control workings.
Since this function uses clock-synchronous serial I/O mode, set this bit to “0” in UART mode.
P70 through P72 conforming to the simplified I 2C bus
P70/TxD2/SDA
To DMA0, DMA1
Timer
Selector
IICM=1
I/O
UART2
IICM=0
D
Noize
Filter
Q
IICM=0
Transmission
register
delay
IICM=1
UART2
To DMA0
Arbitration
T
IICM=1
Timer
UART2 transmission/
NACK interrupt
request
IICM=0
Reception register
UART2
IICM=0
UART2 reception/ACK
interrupt request
DMA1 request
IICM=1
Start condition detection
S
Stop condition detection
I/O
Selector
T
ACK
9th pulse
IICM=1
Internal clock
CLK
IICM=1
Noize
Filter
Noize
Filter
P72/CLK2
D Q
Data bus
(Port P71 output data latch)
UART2
IICM=1
NACK
Q
T
R
Q
Bus busy
D
L-synchronous
output enabling bit
Falling edge
detection
P71/RxD2/SCL
R Q
Bus collision
detection
Bus collision/start, stop
condition detection
interrupt request
IICM=0
External clock
IICM=0
UART2 IICM=0
Selector
I/O
Timer
UART2
Port reading
* With IICM set to 1, the port terminal is to be readable
even if 1 is assigned to P71 of the direction register.
Figure 1.15.26. Functional block diagram for I2C mode
Figure 1.15.26 shows the functional block diagram for I2C mode. Setting “1” in the I2C mode selection bit
(IICM) causes ports P70, P71, and P72 to work as data transmission-reception terminal SDA, clock inputoutput terminal SCL, and port P72 respectively. A delay circuit is added to the SDA transmission output,
so the SDA output changes after SCL fully goes to “L”. An attempt to read Port P71 (SCL) results in
getting the terminal’s level regardless of the content of the port direction register. The initial value of SDA
transmission output in this mode goes to the value set in port P70. The interrupt factors of the bus collision
detection interrupt, UART2 transmission interrupt, and of UART2 reception interrupt turn to the start/stop
condition detection interrupt, acknowledgment non-detection interrupt, and acknowledgment detection
interrupt respectively.
The start condition detection interrupt refers to the interrupt that occurs when the falling edge of the SDA
terminal (P70) is detected with the SCL terminal (P71) staying “H”. The stop condition detection interrupt
refers to the interrupt that occurs when the rising edge of the SDA terminal (P70) is detected with the SCL
terminal (P71) staying “H”. The bus busy flag (bit 2 of the UART2 special mode register) is set to “1” by the
start condition detection, and set to “0” by the stop condition detection.
116
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
UART2 Special Mode Register
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
The acknowledgment non-detection interrupt refers to the interrupt that occurs when the SDA terminal
level is detected still staying “H” at the rising edge of the 9th transmission clock. The acknowledgment
detection interrupt refers to the interrupt that occurs when SDA terminal’s level is detected already went
to “L” at the 9th transmission clock. Also, assigning 1 1 0 1 (UART2 reception) to the DMA1 request factor
select bits provides the means to start up the DMA transfer by the effect of acknowledgment detection.
Bit 1 of the UART2 special mode register (037716) is used as the arbitration loss detecting flag control bit.
Arbitration means the act of detecting the nonconformity between transmission data and SDA terminal
data at the timing of the SCL rising edge. This detecting flag is located at bit 3 of the UART2 reception
buffer register (037F16), and “1” is set in this flag when nonconformity is detected. Use the arbitration lost
detecting flag control bit to choose which way to use to update the flag, bit by bit or byte by byte. When
setting this bit to “1” and updated the flag byte by byte if nonconformity is detected, the arbitration lost
detecting flag is set to “1” at the falling edge of the 9th transmission clock.
If update the flag byte by byte, must judge and clear (“0”) the arbitration lost detecting flag after completing the first byte acknowledge detect and before starting the next one byte transmission.
Bit 3 of the UART2 special mode register is used as SCL- and L-synchronous output enable bit. Setting
this bit to “1” goes the P71 data register to “0” in synchronization with the SCL terminal level going to “L”.
117
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
UART2 Special Mode Register
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Some other functions added are explained here. Figure 1.15.27 shows their workings.
Bit 4 of the UART2 special mode register is used as the bus collision detect sampling clock select bit. The
bus collision detect interrupt occurs when the RxD2 level and TxD2 level do not match, but the nonconformity is detected in synchronization with the rising edge of the transfer clock signal if the bit is set to “0”. If
this bit is set to “1”, the nonconformity is detected at the timing of the overflow of timer A0 rather than at
the rising edge of the transfer clock.
Bit 5 of the UART2 special mode register is used as the auto clear function select bit of transmit enable
bit. Setting this bit to “1” automatically resets the transmit enable bit to “0” when “1” is set in the bus
collision detect interrupt request bit (nonconformity).
Bit 6 of the UART2 special mode register is used as the transmit start condition select bit. Setting this bit
to “1” starts the TxD transmission in synchronization with the falling edge of the RxD terminal.
1. Bus collision detect sampling clock select bit (Bit 4 of the UART2 special mode register)
0: Rising edges of the transfer clock
CLK
TxD/RxD
1: Timer A0 overflow
Timer A0
2. Auto clear function select bit of transmt enable bit (Bit 5 of the UART2 special mode register)
CLK
TxD/RxD
Bus collision
detect interrupt
request bit
Transmit
enable bit
3. Transmit start condition select bit (Bit 6 of the UART2 special mode register)
0: In normal state
CLK
TxD
Enabling transmission
With "1: falling edge of RxD2" selected
CLK
TxD
RxD
Figure 1.15.27. Some other functions added
118
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
UART2 Special Mode Register 2
UART2 Special Mode Register 2
UART2 special mode register 2 (address 037616) is used to further control UART2 in I2C mode. Figure
1.15.28 shows the UART2 special mode register 2.
UART2 special mode register 2
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
U2SMR2
Bit
symbol
Address
037616
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
IICM2
I 2C mode selection bit 2
Refer to Table 1.15.10
CSC
Clock-synchronous bit
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
SWC
SCL wait output bit
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
ASL
SDA output stop bit
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
STAC
UART2 initialization bit
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
SWC2
SCL wait output bit 2
SDHI
SDA output disable bit
0: UART2 clock
1: 0 output
0: Enabled
1: Disabled (high impedance)
SHTC
Start/stop condition
control bit
Set this bit to "1" in I2C mode
(refer to Table 1.15.11)
R W
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
Figure 1.15.28. UART2 special mode register 2
119
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
UART2 Special Mode Register 2
Bit 0 of the UART2 special mode register 2 (address 037616) is used as the I2C mode selection bit 2.
Table 1.15.10 shows the types of control to be changed by I2C mode selection bit 2 when the I2C mode
selection bit is set to "1". Table 1.15.11 shows the timing characteristics of detecting the start condition
and the stop condition. Set the start/stop condition control bit (bit 7 of UART2 special mode register 2) to
"1" in I2C mode.
Table 1.15.10. Functions changed by I2C mode selection bit 2
IICM2 = 0
IICM2 = 1
1 Factor of interrupt number 15
No acknowledgment detection (NACK)
UART2 transmission (the rising edge
of the final bit of the clock)
2 Factor of interrupt number 16
Acknowledgment detection (ACK)
UART2 reception (the falling edge
of the final bit of the clock)
Function
3 DMA1 factor at the time when 1 1 0 1 Acknowledgment detection (ACK)
is assigned to the DMA request
factor selection bits
UART2 reception (the falling edge of
the final bit of the clock)
4 Timing for transferring data from the
UART2 reception shift register to the
reception buffer.
The rising edge of the final bit of the
reception clock
The falling edge of the final bit of the
reception clock
5 Timing for generating a UART2
reception/ACK interrupt request
The rising edge of the final bit of the
reception clock
The falling edge of the final bit of the
reception clock
Table 1.15.11. Timing characteristics of detecting the start condition and the stop condition(Note1)
3 to 6 cycles < duration for setting-up (Note2)
3 to 6 cycles < duration for holding (Note2)
Note 1 : When the start/stop condition count bit is "1" .
Note 2 : "cycles" is in terms of the input oscillation frequency f(XIN) of the main clock.
Duration for
setting up
SCL
SDA
(Start condition)
SDA
(Stop condition)
120
Duration for
holding
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
UART2 Special Mode Register 2
P70/TXD2/SDA
Timer
Selector
To DMA0, DMA1
IICM=0
or
IICM2=1
I/0
UART2
IICM=1
delay
Transmission register
UART2
IICM=0
SDHI
ALS
D
IICM=1
and IICM2=0
To DMA0
Arbitration
Q
T
Noize
Filter
UART2 transmission/
NACK interrupt
request
IICM=0
or IICM2=1
IICM=1
Reception register
IICM=0
UART2
IICM=1
and IICM2=0
Start condition detection
S
R
Q
UART2 reception/ACK interrupt request
DMA1 request
Bus
busy
Stop condition detection
P71/RXD2/SCL
D
L-synchronous
output enabling bit
Falling edge
detection
D
I/0
R
ACK
9th pulse
Selector
UART2
IICM=1
IICM=1
Noize
Filter
Q
T
Data register
Noize
Filter
NACK
Q
T
SWC2
External clock
IICM=0
IICM=1
Internal clock
CLK
control
R
S
Bus collision
detection
Bus collision/start, stop condition detection
interrupt request
IICM=0
UART2
Falling of 9th pulse
SWC
Port reading
UART2
IICM=0
P72/CLK2
Selector
* With IICM set to 1, the port terminal is to be readable
even if 1 is assigned to P71 of the direction register.
I/0
Timer
Figure 1.15.29. Functional block diagram for I2C mode
Functions available in I2C mode are shown in Figure 1.15.29 — a functional block diagram.
Bit 3 of the UART2 special mode register 2 (address 037616) is used as the SDA output stop bit. Setting
this bit to "1" causes an arbitration loss to occur, and the SDA pin turns to high-impedance state the
instant when the arbitration loss detection flag is set to "1".
Bit 1 of the UART2 special mode register 2 (address 037616) is used as the clock synchronization bit.
With this bit set to "1" at the time when the internal SCL is set to "H", the internal SCL turns to "L" if the
falling edge is found in the SCL pin; and the baud rate generator reloads the set value, and start counting
within the "L" interval. When the internal SCL changes from "L" to "H" with the SCL pin set to "L", stops
counting the baud rate generator, and starts counting it again when the SCL pin turns to "H". Due to this
function, the UART2 transmission-reception clock becomes the logical product of the signal flowing
through the internal SCL and that flowing through the SCL pin. This function operates over the period
from the moment earlier by a half cycle than falling edge of the UART2 first clock to the rising edge of the
ninth bit. To use this function, choose the internal clock for the transfer clock.
Bit 2 of the UART2 special mode register 2 (037616) is used as the SCL wait output bit. Setting this bit to
"1" causes the SCL pin to be fixed to "L" at the falling edge of the ninth bit of the clock. Setting this bit to
"0" frees the output fixed to "L".
121
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
UART2 Special Mode Register 2
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Bit 4 of the UART2 special mode register 2 (address 037616) is used as the UART2 initialization bit.
Setting this bit to "1", and when the start condition is detected, the microcomputer operates as follows.
(1) The transmission shift register is initialized, and the content of the transmission register is transferred
to the transmission shift register. This starts transmission by dealing with the clock entered next as the
first bit. The UART2 output value, however, doesn’t change until the first bit data is output after the
entrance of the clock, and remains unchanged from the value at the moment when the microcomputer
detected the start condition.
(2) The reception shift register is initialized, and the microcomputer starts reception by dealing with the
clock entered next as the first bit.
(3) The SCL wait output bit turns to "1". This turns the SCL pin to "L" at the falling edge of the ninth bit of
the clock.
Starting to transmit/receive signals to/from UART2 using this function doesn’t change the value of the
transmission buffer empty flag. To use this function, choose the external clock for the transfer clock.
Bit 5 of the UART2 special mode register 2 (037616) is used as the SCL pin wait output bit 2. Setting this
bit to "1" with the serial I/O specified allows the user to forcibly output an "L" from the SCL pin even if
UART2 is in operation. Setting this bit to "0" frees the "L" output from the SCL pin, and the UART2 clock
is input/output.
Bit 6 of the UART2 special mode register 2 (037616) is used as the SDA output disable bit. Setting this bit
to "1" forces the SDA pin to turn to the high-impedance state. Refrain from changing the value of this bit
at the rising edge of the UART2 transfer clock. There can be instances in which arbitration lost detection
flag is turned on.
122
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
LCD Drive Control Circuit
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
LCD Drive Control Circuit
The M30220 group has the built-in Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) drive control circuit consisting of the following.
• LCD display RAM
• Segment output enable register
• LCD mode register
• Voltage multiplier
• Selector
• Timing controller
• Common driver
• Segment driver
• Bias control circuit
A maximum of 48 segment output pins and 4 common output pins can be used.
Up to 192 pixels can be controlled for LCD display. When the LCD enable bit is set to “1” after data is set in
the LCD mode register, the segment output enable register and the LCD display RAM, the LCD drive control
circuit starts reading the display data automatically, performs the bias control and the duty ratio control, and
displays the data on the LCD panel. When using the LCDRAM output function, all segment output pins that
have been selected for segment output by the segment output enable register output the content of the
corresponding LCDRAM bit 0 or bit 4 when the LCDRAM output enable bit is set to “1” while the time
division select bits = “00” and the LCD output enable bit = “0”.
Table 1.16.1 shows maximum number of display pixels at each duty ratio. Figure 1.16.1 shows the block
diagram of LCD controller / driver.
Set the duty ratio select bits to “002” when writing the data to the LCDRAM.
Table 1.16.1. Maximum number of display pixels at each duty ratio
Duty ratio
2
3
4
Maximum number of display pixel
96 dots or 8 segment LCD 12 digits
144 dots or 8 segment LCD 18 digits
192 dots or 8 segment LCD 24 digits
123
124
Address 010116
Figure 1.16.1. Block diagram of LCD controller/driver
Level
shift
Level
shift
Level
shift
SEG1
SEG2
SEG3
P06/SEG46 P07/SEG47
VCC
VSS VL1 VL2 VL3 C1 C2
Level
Shift
Level
Shift
Level
Shift
Timing controller
2
Level
Shift
Duty ratio selection bits
COM0 COM1 COM2 COM3
Common Common Common Common
driver
driver
driver
driver
LCD output
enable bit
Bias control bit
Bias control
Voltage multiplier
control bit
LCD display
RAM
LCD enable bit
LCDCK
1/8
LCD frame frequency control counter (8)
Reload register (8)
“1”
“0”
LCDCK count source
select bit
1/2
f32
fC1
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SEG0
Level
shift
Segment Segment
driver
driver
Level
shift
Selector Selector
Address 011716
LCD Drive Control Circuit
Segment Segment Segment Segment
driver
driver
driver
driver
Level
shift
Selector Selector Selector Selector
Address 010016
Data bus low-order bits
Data bus high-order bits
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
M30220 Group
t
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
LCD Drive Control Circuit
LCD mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
LCDM
Address
012016
Bit name
Bit symbol
LCDT0
When reset
0X0000002
Duty ratio select bit
LCDT1
Function
0 0 : Not used
0 1 : 2 duty (use COM0, COM1)
1 0 : 3 duty (use COM0–COM2)
1 1 : 4 duty (use COM0–COM3)
0 : 1/3 bias
1 : 1/2 bias
BIAS
Bias control bit
LCDEN
LCD enable bit
0 : LCD OFF
1 : LCD ON
PUMP
Voltage multiplier
control bit
0 : Voltage multiplier disable
1 : Voltage multiplier enable
LCDRAM output bit
0 : LCD waveform output
1 : LCDRAM data output
LRAMOUT
R W
b1 b0
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
LCDCK count source
0 : f32
LSRC
select bit (Note)
1 : fC1
Note : LCDCK is a clock for a LCD timing controller.
Segment output enable register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
SEG
Address
012216
When reset
0016
Bit name
Bit symbol
Function
Segment output enable
bit 0
Segment output enable
bit 1
Segment output enable
bit 2
Segment output enable
bit 3
0 : I/O ports P100 to P107
1 : Segment output SEG16 to SEG23
0 : I/O ports P110 to P114
1 : Segment output SEG24 to SEG28
0 : I/O ports P115, P116
1 : Segment output SEG29, SEG30
0 : I/O ports P117
1 : Segment output SEG31
Segment output enable
bit 4
Segment output enable
bit 5
0 : I/O ports P120 to P125
1 : Segment output SEG32 to SEG37
0 : I/O ports P126 to P127
1 : Segment output SEG38 to SEG39
SEGO6
Segment output enable
bit 6
0 : I/O ports P00 to P07
1 : Segment output SEG40 to SEG47
SEGO7
LCD output enable bit
0 : disable
1 : enable
SEGO0
SEGO1
SEGO2
SEGO3
SEGO4
SEGO5
RW
LCD frame frequency counter (Note)
b7
b0
Symbol
LCDTIM
Address
012416
Function
8 bits timer
When reset
XX16
Values that can be set
R W
0016 to FF16
Note: Set this register when LCD output enable bit is “0” (disable).
Figure 1.16.2. LCD-related registers
125
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
LCD Drive Control Circuit
Voltage Multiplier
The voltage multiplier performs threefold boosting. This circuit inputs a reference voltage for boosting
from LCD power input pin VL1. (However, when using a 1/2 bias, connect VL1 and VL2 and apply voltage
by external resistor division.)
To activate the voltage multiplier, choose the segment/port and duty rate, select bias control, and set up
the LCD frame frequency counter and LCDCK count source using the segment enable register and LCD
mode register, then enable the LCD output enable bit (bit 7 at address 012216) and set the voltage
multiplier control bit (bit 4 at address 012016) to “1” (= voltage multiplier enabled).
When voltage is input to the VL1 pin during operating the voltage multiplier, voltage that is twice as large
as VL1 occurs at the VL2 pin, and voltage that is three times as large as VL1 occurs at the VL3 pin.
The voltage multiplier control bit (bit 4 of the address 012016) controls the voltage multiplier.
When using the voltage multiplier, apply a voltage equal to or greater than 1.3 V but not exceeding 2.1 V
to the VL1 pin before enabling the voltage multiplier control bit.
When not using the voltage multiplier, enable the LCD output enable bit and apply an appropriate voltage
to the LCD power supply input pins (VL1 to VL3). When the LCD output enable bit is disabled, the VL3 pin
is connected to VCC internally.
Bias Control and Applied Voltage to LCD Power Input Pins
To the LCD power input pins (VL1 to VL3), apply the voltage shown in Table 1.16.2 according to the bias value.
Select a bias value by the bias control bit (bit 2 of the address 012016).
Table 1.16.2. Bias control and applied voltage to VL1 to VL3
Bias value
Voltage value
VL3 = VLCD
VL2 = 2/3 VLCD
VL1 = 1/3 VLCD
VL3 = VLCD
VL2 = VL1 = 1/2 VLCD
1/3 bias
1/2 bias
Note : VLCD is the maximum value of supplied voltage for the LCD panel.
Contrast control
VL3
VL3
Contrast control
VL3
VL3
R1
VL2
VL2
C2
C2
Open
C1
C1
Open
VL1
VL1
R4
VL2
VL2
C2
Open
C1
Open
R2
VL1
R3
R5
R1=R2=R3
1/3 bias
when using the voltage multiplier
1/3 bias
when not using the voltage multiplier
Figure 1.16.3. Example of circuit at each bias
126
C1
Open
C2
Open
VL1
R4=R5
1/2 bias
When selecting LCDRAM data output
(not using LCD panel)
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
LCD Drive Control Circuit
Common Pin and Duty Ratio Control
The common pins (COM0 to COM3) to be used are determined by duty ratio.
Select duty ratio by the duty ratio select bits (bits 0 and 1 of address 012016).
Table 1.16.3. Duty ratio control and common pins used
Duty
Duty ratio select bit
Common pins used
ratio
Bit 1
Bit 0
2
0
1
COM0, COM1 (Note 1)
3
1
0
COM0 to COM2 (Note 2)
4
1
1
COM0 to COM3
Note 1 : COM2 and COM3 are open.
Note 2 : COM3 is open.
LCD Display RAM
Address 010016 to 011716 is the designated RAM for the LCD display. When “1” are written to these
addresses, the corresponding segments of the LCD display panel are turned on.
Figure 1.16.4 shows the LCD display RAM map.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
Address
010016
010116
010216
010316
010416
010516
010616
010716
010816
010916
010A16
010B16
010C16
010D16
010E16
010F16
011016
011116
011216
011316
011416
011516
011616
011716
SEG1
SEG3
SEG0
SEG2
SEG5
SEG7
SEG9
SEG4
SEG6
SEG8
SEG11
SEG13
SEG10
SEG12
SEG15
SEG17
SEG19
SEG14
SEG16
SEG18
SEG21
SEG23
SEG20
SEG22
SEG25
SEG27
SEG29
SEG24
SEG26
SEG28
SEG31
SEG33
SEG35
SEG30
SEG32
SEG34
SEG37
SEG39
SEG41
SEG43
SEG36
SEG38
SEG40
SEG42
SEG45
SEG44
SEG47
SEG46
COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0
Figure 1.16.4. LCD display RAM map
LCD Drive Timing
The LCDCK timing frequency (LCD drive timing) is generated internally and the frame frequency can be
determined with the following equation. The LCDCK count source frequency is fC1 (same frequency as
XCIN) or f32 (divide-by-32 of XIN frequency).
f(LCDCK)=
(frequency of count source for LCDCK)
16 X (LCD frame frequency count value + 1)
Frame frequency=
f(LCDCK)
duty ratio
127
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
LCD Drive Control Circuit
Figure 1.16.5 shows the LCD drive waveform (1/2 bias), Figure 1.16.6 shows the LCD drive waveform
(1/3 bias).
Internal logic
LCDCK timing
1/4 duty
Voltage level
VL3
VL2=VL1
VSS
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM3
VL3
VSS
SEG0
OFF
COM3
ON
COM2
COM1
OFF
COM0
COM3
ON
COM2
COM1
COM0
1/3 duty
VL3
VL2=VL1
VSS
COM0
COM1
COM2
VL3
VSS
SEG0
ON
OFF
COM0
COM2
ON
COM1
OFF
COM0
COM2
ON
COM1
OFF
COM0
COM2
1/2 duty
VL3
VL2=VL1
VSS
COM0
COM1
VL3
VSS
SEG0
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
COM1
COM0
COM1
COM0
COM1
COM0
COM1
COM0
Figure 1.16.5. LCD drive waveform (1/2 bias)
128
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
LCD Drive Control Circuit
Internal logic
LCDCK timing
1/4 duty
Voltage level
VL3
VL2
VL1
VSS
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM3
VL3
SEG0
VSS
OFF
COM3
ON
COM2
COM1
OFF
COM0
COM3
ON
COM2
COM1
COM0
1/3 duty
VL3
VL2
VL1
VSS
COM0
COM1
COM2
VL3
SEG0
VSS
ON
OFF
COM0
COM2
ON
COM1
OFF
COM0
COM2
ON
COM1
OFF
COM0
COM2
1/2 duty
VL3
VL2
VL1
VSS
COM0
COM1
VL3
SEG0
VSS
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
COM1
COM0
COM1
COM0
COM1
COM0
COM1
COM0
Figure 1.16.6. LCD drive waveform (1/3 bias)
129
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
A-D Converter
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
A-D Converter
The A-D converter consists of one 10-bit successive approximation A-D converter circuit with a capacitive coupling
amplifier. Pins P90 to P97 also function as the analog signal input pins. The direction registers of these pins for AD conversion must therefore be set to input. The Vref connect bit (bit 5 at address 03D716) can be used to isolate
the resistance ladder of the A-D converter from the reference voltage input pin (VREF) when the A-D converter is not
used. Doing so stops any current flowing into the resistance ladder from VREF, reducing the power dissipation.
When using the A-D converter, start A-D conversion only after setting bit 5 of 03D716 to connect VREF.
The result of A-D conversion is stored in the A-D registers of the selected pins. When set to 10-bit precision, the low
8 bits are stored in the even addresses and the high 2 bits in the odd addresses. When set to 8-bit precision, the low
8 bits are stored in the even addresses.
Table 1.17.1 shows the performance of the A-D converter. Figure 1.17.1 shows the block diagram of the
A-D converter, and Figures 1.17.2 and 1.17.3 show the A-D converter-related registers.
Table 1.17.1. Performance of A-D converter
Item
Performance
Method of A-D conversion Successive approximation (capacitive coupling amplifier)
Analog input voltage (Note 1) 0V to AVCC (VCC)
Operating clock φAD (Note 2) VCC = 5V fAD/divide-by-2 of fAD/divide-by-4 of fAD, fAD=f(XIN)
VCC = 3V divide-by-2 of fAD/divide-by-4 of fAD, fAD=f(XIN)
Resolution
8-bit or 10-bit (selectable)
Absolute precision
VCC = 5V • Without sample and hold function
±3LSB
• With sample and hold function (8-bit resolution)
±2LSB
• With sample and hold function (10-bit resolution)
±3LSB
VCC = 3V • Without sample and hold function (8-bit resolution)
±2LSB
Operating modes
One-shot mode, repeat mode, single sweep mode, repeat sweep mode 0,
and repeat sweep mode 1
Analog input pins
8pins (AN0 to AN7)
A-D conversion start condition • Software trigger
A-D conversion starts when the A-D conversion start flag changes to “1”
• External trigger (can be retriggered)
A-D conversion starts when the A-D conversion start flag is “1” and the
___________
ADTRG/P130 input changes from “H” to “L”
Conversion speed per pin • Without sample and hold function
8-bit resolution: 49 φAD cycles, 10-bit resolution: 59 φAD cycles
• With sample and hold function
8-bit resolution: 28 φAD cycles, 10-bit resolution: 33 φAD cycles
Note 1: Does not depend on use of sample and hold function.
Note 2: Without sample and hold function, set the φAD frequency to 250kHZ min.
With the sample and hold function, set the φAD frequency to 1MHZ min.
130
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
A-D Converter
CKS1=1
φAD
CKS0=1
fAD
1/2
1/2
CKS0=0
CKS1=0
A-D conversion rate
selection
V REF
VCUT=0
Resistor ladder
AV SS
VCUT=1
Successive conversion register
A-D control register 1 (address 03D716)
A-D control register 0 (address 03D616)
Addresses
(03C116, 03C016)
A-D register 0(16)
(03C316, 03C216)
A-D register 1(16)
A-D register 2(16)
A-D register 3(16)
(03C516, 03C416)
(03C716, 03C616)
(03C916, 03C816)
A-D register 4(16)
(03CB16, 03CA16)
(03CD16, 03CC16)
A-D register 5(16)
A-D register 6(16)
(03CF16, 03CE16)
A-D register 7(16)
Vref
Decoder
VIN
Comparator
Data bus high-order
Data bus low-order
P90/AN0
CH2,CH1,CH0=000
P91/AN1
CH2,CH1,CH0=001
P92/AN2
CH2,CH1,CH0=010
P93/AN3
CH2,CH1,CH0=011
P94/AN4
CH2,CH1,CH0=100
P95/AN5
CH2,CH1,CH0=101
P96/AN6
CH2,CH1,CH0=110
P97/AN7
CH2,CH1,CH0=111
Figure 1.17.1. Block diagram of A-D converter
AA
AA
ADGSEL0 = 0
AA
AA
131
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
A-D Converter
A-D control register 0 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit symbol
Address
03D616
When reset
00000XXX2
Bit name
Function
CH0
Analog input pin select bit
CH1
CH2
0 0 0 : AN0 is selected
0 0 1 : AN1 is selected
0 1 0 : AN2 is selected
0 1 1 : AN3 is selected
1 0 0 : AN4 is selected
1 0 1 : AN5 is selected
1 1 0 : AN6 is selected
1 1 1 : AN7 is selected
0 0 : One-shot mode
0 1 : Repeat mode
1 0 : Single sweep mode
1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 0
Repeat sweep mode 1
Trigger select bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
ADST
A-D conversion start flag
0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
CKS0
Frequency select bit 0
0 : fAD/4 is selected
1 : fAD/2 is selected
MD0
MD1
TRG
(Note 2)
b4 b3
A-D operation mode
select bit 0
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
RW
b2 b1 b0
(Note 2)
Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is
indeterminate.
Note 2: When changing A-D operation mode, set analog input pin again.
A-D control register 1 (Note)
b7
b6
0 0
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON1
Bit symbol
Address
03D716
When reset
0016
Bit name
A-D sweep pin select bit
SCAN0
Function
When single sweep and repeat sweep
mode 0 are selected
b1 b0
0 0 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
0 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN5 (6 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
When repeat sweep mode 1 is selected
SCAN1
b1 b0
0 0 : AN0 (1 pin)
0 1 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN2 (3 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
MD2
A-D operation mode
select bit 1
0 : Any mode other than repeat sweep
mode 1
1 : Repeat sweep mode 1
BITS
8/10-bit mode select bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
CKS1
Frequency select bit 1
0 : fAD/2 or fAD/4 is selected
1 : fAD is selected
Vref connect bit
0 : Vref not connected
1 : Vref connected
VCUT
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
RW
Always set to “0”.
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is
indeterminate.
Figure 1.17.2. A-D converter-related registers (1)
132
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
A-D Converter
A-D control register 2 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0 0
Symbol
Address
When reset
ADCON2
03D416
0000XXX02
Bit symbol
SMP
Bit name
A-D conversion method
select bit
Function
0 : Without sample and hold
1 : With sample and hold
Always set to “0”
Reserved bit
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to
be “0”.
A
A
A
A
AA
RW
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion
result is indeterminate.
Symbol
A-D register i
(b15)
b7
ADi(i=0 to 7)
(b8)
b0 b7
Address
When reset
03C016 to 03CF16 Indeterminate
b0
Function
Eight low-order bits of A-D conversion result
• During 10-bit mode
Two high-order bits of A-D conversion result
• During 8-bit mode
When read, the content is indeterminate
A
A
A
R W
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if
read, turns out to be “0”.
Figure 1.17.3. A-D converter-related registers (2)
133
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
A-D Converter
(1) One-shot mode
In one-shot mode, the pin selected using the analog input pin select bit is used for one-shot A-D conversion. Table 1.17.2 shows the specifications of one-shot mode. Figure 1.17.4 shows the A-D control register in one-shot mode.
Table 1.17.2. One-shot mode specifications
Item
Function
Start condition
Stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
Input pin
Reading of result of A-D converter
Specification
The pin selected by the analog input pin select bit is used for one A-D conversion
Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag
• End of A-D conversion (A-D conversion start flag changes to “0”, except
when external trigger is selected)
• Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag
End of A-D conversion
One of AN0 to AN7, as selected
Read A-D register corresponding to selected pin
A-D control register 0 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit symbol
CH0
Address
03D616
Bit name
Analog input pin select
bit
CH1
CH2
MD0
When reset
00000XXX2
Function
0 0 0 : AN0 is selected
0 0 1 : AN1 is selected
0 1 0 : AN2 is selected
0 1 1 : AN3 is selected
1 0 0 : AN4 is selected
1 0 1 : AN5 is selected
1 1 0 : AN6 is selected
1 1 1 : AN7 is selected
MD1
TRG
Trigger select bit
ADST
A-D conversion start flag 0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
0: fAD/4 is selected
Frequency select bit 0
1: fAD/2 is selected
CKS0
(Note 2)
b4 b3
A-D operation mode
select bit 0
0 0 : One-shot mode
A
AA
AA
A
A
RW
b2 b1 b0
(Note 2)
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion
result is indeterminate.
Note 2: When changing A-D operation mode, set analog input pin again.
A-D control register 1 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
0 0 1
b4
b3
b2
0
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON1
Bit symbol
Address
03D716
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
A-D sweep pin
select bit
Invalid in one-shot mode
MD2
A-D operation mode
select bit 1
0 : Any mode other than repeat sweep
mode 1
BITS
8/10-bit mode select bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
CKS1
Frequency select bit1
0 : fAD/2 or fAD/4 is selected
1 : fAD is selected
VCUT
Vref connect bit
1 : Vref connected
SCAN0
SCAN1
Always set to “0”.
A
AA
AA
A
RW
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion
result is indeterminate.
Figure 1.17.4. A-D conversion register in one-shot mode
134
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
A-D Converter
(2) Repeat mode
In repeat mode, the pin selected using the analog input pin select bit is used for repeated A-D conversion.
Table 1.17.3 shows the specifications of repeat mode. Figure 1.17.5 shows the A-D control register in
repeat mode.
Table 1.17.3. Repeat mode specifications
Item
Specification
The pin selected by the analog input pin select bit is used for repeated A-D conversion
Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag
Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag
None generated
One of AN0 to AN7, as selected
Read A-D register corresponding to selected pin
Function
Star condition
Stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
Input pin
Reading of result of A-D converter
A-D control register 0 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 1
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit symbol
CH0
Address
03D616
When reset
00000XXX2
Bit name
Analog input pin
select bit
CH1
CH2
Function
0 0 0 : AN0 is selected
0 0 1 : AN1 is selected
0 1 0 : AN2 is selected
0 1 1 : AN3 is selected
1 0 0 : AN4 is selected
1 0 1 : AN5 is selected
1 1 0 : AN6 is selected
1 1 1 : AN7 is selected
MD1
A-D operation mode
select bit 0
b4 b3
TRG
Trigger select bit
ADST
A-D conversion start flag
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
CKS0
Frequency select bit 0
MD0
0 1 : Repeat mode
AAA
AAA
AAA
AAAA
AA
A
AA
A
AA
AAA
AAA
RW
b2 b1 b0
(Note 2)
(Note 2)
0 : fAD/4 is selected
1 : fAD/2 is selected
Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion
result is indeterminate.
Note 2: When changing A-D operation mode, set analog input pin again.
A-D control register 1 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
0 0 1
b4
b3
b2
0
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON1
Bit symbol
Address
03D716
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
A-D sweep pin
select bit
Invalid in repeat mode
A-D operation mode
select bit 1
0 : Any mode other than repeat sweep mode 1
8/10-bit mode select bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
CKS1
Frequency select bit 1
0 : fAD/2 or fAD/4 is selected
1 : fAD is selected
VCUT
Vref connect bit
1 : Vref connected
SCAN0
SCAN1
MD2
BITS
Always set to “0”.
AAA
AAA
AA
AAA
A
AAA
AA
A
RW
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion
result is indeterminate.
Figure 1.17.5. A-D conversion register in repeat mode
135
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
A-D Converter
(3) Single sweep mode
In single sweep mode, the pins selected using the A-D sweep pin select bit are used for one-by-one A-D
conversion. Table 1.17.4 shows the specifications of single sweep mode. Figure 1.17.6 shows the A-D
control register in single sweep mode.
Table 1.17.4. Single sweep mode specifications
Item
Specification
Function
The pins selected by the A-D sweep pin select bit are used for one-by-one A-D conversion
Start condition
Writing “1” to A-D converter start flag
Stop condition
• End of A-D conversion (A-D conversion start flag changes to “0”, except
when external trigger is selected)
• Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag
Interrupt request generation timing End of A-D conversion
Input pin
AN0 and AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN3 (4 pins), AN0 to AN5 (6 pins), or AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
Reading of result of A-D converter Read A-D register corresponding to selected pin
A-D control register 0 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 0
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit symbol
CH0
Address
03D616
When reset
00000XXX2
Bit name
Analog input pin
select bit
Function
Invalid in single sweep mode
CH1
CH2
MD0
A-D operation mode
select bit 0
b4 b3
1 0 : Single sweep mode
MD1
TRG
ADST
CKS0
Trigger select bit
A-D conversion start flag
Frequency select bit 0
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
0 : fAD/4 is selected
1 : fAD/2 is selected
AAA
AA
A
A
AA
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AA
AAA
A
RW
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
A-D control register 1 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
0 0 1
b4
b3
b2
0
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON1
Bit symbol
SCAN0
Address
03D716
When reset
0016
Bit name
A-D sweep pin select bit
Function
When single sweep and repeat sweep mode 0
are selected
b1 b0
0 0 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
0 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN5 (6 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
SCAN1
MD2
A-D operation mode
select bit 1
0 : Any mode other than repeat sweep mode 1
BITS
8/10-bit mode select bit
CKS1
Frequency select bit 1
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
0 : fAD/2 or fAD/4 is selected
1 : fAD is selected
VCUT
Vref connect bit
1 : Vref connected
Always set to “0”.
AAA
A
AA
AAA
AA
AAA
AAA
A
R W
Note : If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
Figure 1.17.6. A-D conversion register in single sweep mode
136
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
A-D Converter
(4) Repeat sweep mode 0
In repeat sweep mode 0, the pins selected using the A-D sweep pin select bit are used for repeat sweep
A-D conversion. Table 1.17.5 shows the specifications of repeat sweep mode 0. Figure 1.17.7 shows the
A-D control register in repeat sweep mode 0.
Table 1.17.5. Repeat sweep mode 0 specifications
Item
Function
Start condition
Stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
Input pin
Reading of result of A-D converter
Specification
The pins selected by the A-D sweep pin select bit are used for repeat sweep A-D conversion
Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag
Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag
None generated
AN0 and AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN3 (4 pins), AN0 to AN5 (6 pins), or AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
Read A-D register corresponding to selected pin (at any time)
A-D control register 0 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
1 1
b0
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit symbol
CH0
Address
03D616
When reset
00000XXX2
Bit name
Analog input pin
select bit
Function
Invalid in repeat sweep mode 0
CH1
CH2
MD0
A-D operation mode
select bit 0
b4 b3
1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 0
MD1
TRG
ADST
CKS0
Trigger select bit
A-D conversion start flag
Frequency select bit 0
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
0 : fAD/4 is selected
1 : fAD/2 is selected
A
AA
A
AA
A
A
RW
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
A-D control register 1 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
0 0 1
b4
b3
b2
0
b1
Symbol
ADCON1
Address
03D716
Bit symbol
SCAN0
When reset
0016
Bit name
A-D sweep pin select bit
Function
When single sweep and repeat sweep mode 0
are selected
b1 b0
0 0 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
0 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN5 (6 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
SCAN1
A-D operation mode
select bit 1
0 : Any mode other than repeat sweep mode 1
8/10-bit mode select bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
CKS1
Frequency select bit 1
0 : fAD/2 or fAD/4 is selected
1 : fAD is selected
VCUT
Vref connect bit
1 : Vref connected
MD2
BITS
Always set to “0”.
AA
AA
A
AA
RW
Note : If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
Figure 1.17.7. A-D conversion register in repeat sweep mode 0
137
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
A-D Converter
(5) Repeat sweep mode 1
In repeat sweep mode 1, all pins are used for A-D conversion with emphasis on the pin or pins selected
using the A-D sweep pin select bit. Table 1.17.6 shows the specifications of repeat sweep mode 1. Figure
1.17.8 shows the A-D control register in repeat sweep mode 1.
Table 1.17.6. Repeat sweep mode 1 specifications
Item
Specification
All pins perform repeat sweep A-D conversion, with emphasis on the pin or
pins selected by the A-D sweep pin select bit
Example : AN0 selected AN0
AN1
AN0
AN2
AN0
AN3, etc
Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag
Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag
None generated
AN0 (1 pin), AN0 and AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN2 (3 pins), AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
Read A-D register corresponding to selected pin (at any time)
Function
Start condition
Stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
Input pin
Reading of result of A-D converter
A-D control register 0 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 1
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit symbol
CH0
Address
03D616
When reset
00000XXX2
Bit name
Analog input pin
select bit
Function
Invalid in repeat sweep mode 1
CH1
CH2
MD0
A-D operation mode
select bit 0
b4 b3
1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 1
MD1
TRG
ADST
CKS0
Trigger select bit
A-D conversion start flag
Frequency select bit 0
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
0 : fAD/4 is selected
1 : fAD/2 is selected
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
RW
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
A-D control register 1 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
0 0 1
b4
b3
b2
1
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON1
Address
03D716
Bit symbol
Bit name
SCAN0
A-D sweep pin select bit
When reset
0016
Function
When repeat sweep mode 1 is selected
b1 b0
0 0 : AN0 (1 pin)
0 1 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN2 (3 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
SCAN1
MD2
A-D operation mode
select bit 1
1 : Repeat sweep mode 1
BITS
8/10-bit mode select bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
CKS1
Frequency select bit 1
0 : fAD/2 or fAD/4 is selected
1 : fAD is selected
VCUT
Vref connect bit
1 : Vref connected
Always set to “0”.
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
R W
Note : If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
Figure 1.17.8. A-D conversion register in repeat sweep mode 1
138
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
A-D Converter
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Sample and hold
Sample and hold is selected by setting bit 0 of the A-D control register 2 (address 03D416) to “1”. When
sample and hold is selected, the rate of conversion of each pin increases. As a result, a 28 fAD cycle is
achieved with 8-bit resolution and 33 fAD with 10-bit resolution. Sample and hold can be selected in all
modes. However, in all modes, be sure to specify before starting A-D conversion whether sample and
hold is to be used.
139
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
D-A Converter
D-A Converter
This is an 8-bit, R-2R type D-A converter. The microcomputer contains three independent D-A converters
of this type.
D-A conversion is performed when a value is written to the corresponding D-A register. Bits 0 to 2 (D-A
output enable bits) of the D-A control register decide if the result of conversion is to be output. Do not set the
target port to output mode if D-A conversion is to be performed.
Output analog voltage (V) is determined by a set value (n : decimal) in the D-A register.
V = VREF X n/ 256 (n = 0 to 255)
VREF : reference voltage
Table 1.18.1 lists the performance of the D-A converter. Figure 1.18.1 shows the block diagram of the D-A
converter. Figure 1.18.2 shows the D-A control register. Figure 1.18.3 shows the D-A converter equivalent
circuit.
Table 1.18.1. Performance of D-A converter
Item
Conversion method
Resolution
Analog output pin
Performance
R-2R method
8 bits
3 channels
Data bus low-order bits
D-A register0 (8)
(Address 03D816)
AAA
AAA
D-A0 output enable bit
P130/DA0
R-2R resistor ladder
D-A register1 (8)
(Address 03DA16)
AAA
AAA
D-A1 output enable bit
P131/DA1
R-2R resistor ladder
D-A register2 (8)
(Address 03DE16)
D-A2 output enable bit
R-2R resistor ladder
Figure 1.18.1. Block diagram of D-A converter
140
AAAAA
P132/DA2
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
D-A Converter
D-A control register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
DACON
b0
Address
03DC16
Bit symbol
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
DA0E
D-A0 output enable bit
0 : Output disabled
1 : Output enabled
DA1E
D-A1 output enable bit
0 : Output disabled
1 : Output enabled
DA2E
D-A2 output enable bit
0 : Output disabled
1 : Output enabled
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
D-A register
b7
Symbol
DAi (i = 0 to 2)
b0
Address
03D816, 03DA16, 03DE16
AAA
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
RW
When reset
Indeterminate
AA
A
AAA
Function
RW
R
W
Output value of D-A conversion
Figure 1.18.2. D-A control register
D-A0 output enable bit
“0”
R
R
R
R
2R
2R
2R
2R
R
R
R
2R
DA0
“1”
2R
MSB
2R
2R
2R
LSB
D-A0 register0
“0”
“1”
AVSS
VREF
Note 1: The above diagram shows an instance in which the D-A register is assigned 2A16.
Note 2: The same circuit as this is also used for D-A1 and D-A2.
Note 3: To reduce the current consumption when the D-A converter is not used, set the D-A output enable bit to 0 and set the D-A register to 0016
so that no current flows in the resistors Rs and 2Rs.
Figure 1.18.3. D-A converter equivalent circuit
141
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Programmable I/O Port
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Programmable I/O Ports
There are 104 programmable I/O ports: P0 to P13 (excluding P77). Each port can be set independently for
input or output using the direction register. A pull-up resistance for each block of 4 ports can be set. P77 is
an input-only port and has no built-in pull-up resistance.
Figures 1.19.1 to 1.19.4 show the programmable I/O ports. Figure 1.19.5 shows the I/O pins.
Each pin functions as a programmable I/O port and as the I/O for the built-in peripheral devices.
To use the pins as the inputs for the built-in peripheral devices, set the direction register of each pin to input
mode. When the pins are used as the outputs for the built-in peripheral devices (other than the D-A converter), they function as outputs regardless of the contents of the direction registers. When pins are to be
used as the outputs for the D-A converter, do not set the direction registers to output mode. See the
descriptions of the respective functions for how to set up the built-in peripheral devices.
(1) Direction registers
Figure 1.19.6 shows the direction registers.
These registers are used to choose the direction of the programmable I/O ports. Each bit in these registers corresponds one for one to each I/O pin.
Note: There is no direction register bit for P77.
(2) Port registers
Figure 1.19.7 shows the port registers.
These registers are used to write and read data for input and output to and from an external device. A
port register consists of a port latch to hold output data and a circuit to read the status of a pin. Each bit
in port registers corresponds one for one to each I/O pin.
(3) Pull-up control registers
Figure 1.19.8 shows the pull-up control registers.
The pull-up control register can be set to apply a pull-up resistance to each block of 4 ports. When ports
are set to have a pull-up resistance, the pull-up resistance is connected only when the direction register is
set for input. The pull-up resistance is not connected for pins that are set for output from peripheral
functions, regardless of the setting in the pull-up control register. When pull-up is ON for ports P1 and P2,
an intermittent pull-up that pulls up the port for only a set period of time, can be performed from the key
input mode register.
(4) Key input mode register
Figure 1.19.9 shows the key input mode register.
With bits 0 and 1 of this register, it is possible to select both edges or the fall edge of the key input for P1
and P2. Also, with bit 2, it is possible to make the pull-up for a port (P1 or P2), which is set for pull-up using
the pull-up control register, automatically connect as an intermittent pull-up. And, using the significant 3
bits, the pull-up resistance can be connected to and disconnected from ports P12 and P13.
(5) Real-time port control register
Figure 1.19.10 shows the real-time port control register. The real-time port control register can be used to
set the registers of ports P0, P1, P2 and P12 for real-time port output, whereby output is synchronized
with timer overflow of timers A0, A1, A5 and A6 in the timer mode. For details, see “Real-time Port”.
142
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Programmable I/O Port
P00 to P07, P120 to P127
VL3/VCC
Direction register
VL2/VCC
VL3/VCC
LCD drive timing
“1”
“1”
Interface logic
level shift circuit
Data bus
Port latch
Segment output
VL1/VSS
Port/segment
D
Timer A
overflow
Q
Port ON/OFF
CK
P10 to P17, P20 to P27
Intermittent pull-up control
Pull-up selection
Direction register
“1”
Port latch
Data bus
D Q
Timer A
overflow
CK
Q D
P30 to P33, P41, P43, P45, P47, P50 to P56, P62, P66, P74 to P76, P81, P83, P85, P87
CK
Intermittent pull-up control
Pull-up selected
Direction register
Data bus
Port latch
P34, P35
Pull-up selection
Direction register
Data bus
Port latch
Figure 1.19.1. Programmable I/O ports (1)
143
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Programmable I/O Port
Pull-up selection
P40, P42, P44, P46, P60,
P61, P64, P65, P72, P73,
P80, P82, P84, P86
Direction register
“1”
Output
Data bus
Port latch
Input respective peripheral functions
Pull-up selection
P57, P63, P67
Direction register
“1”
Output
Data bus
Port latch
Direction register
P70, P71
“1”
Output
Data bus
Port latch
Input respective peripheral functions
P77
Data bus
NMI interrupt input
Figure 1.19.2. Programmable I/O ports (2)
144
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Programmable I/O Port
P90 to P97
Pull-up selection
Direction register
Data bus
Port latch
Analog input
P100 to P107, P110 to P117
VL3/VCC
Direction register
VL2/VCC
VL3/VCC
LCD drive timing
“1”
Interface logic
level shift circuit
Data bus
Port latch
Segment output
VL1/VSS
Port/segment
Port ON/OFF
P130
Pull-up selection
Direction register
Data bus
Port latch
Input respective peripheral functions
Analog output
Figure 1.19.3. Programmable I/O ports (3)
145
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Programmable I/O Port
P131, P132
Pull-up selection
Direction register
Data bus
Port latch
Analog output
COM0 to COM3, SEG0 to SEG15
VL3
VL2
VL1
The gate input signal of each
transistor is controlled by the
LCD duty ratio and the bias
value.
VSS
Figure 1.19.4. Programmable I/O ports (4)
RESET
RESET signal input
(Note)
Note :
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Do not apply a voltage higher than VCC to each pin.
Figure 1.19.5. I/O pins
146
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Programmable I/O Port
Port Pi direction register (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PDi ( i = 0 to 12 except 3 and 7)
Bit symbol
PDi_0
Address
03E216, 03E316, 03E616, 03EA16,
03EB16, 03EE16, 03F216, 03F316,
03F616, 03F716, 03FA16
Bit name
When reset
0016
Function
RW
Port Pi0 direction register
PDi_1
Port Pi1 direction register
PDi_2
Port Pi2 direction register
PDi_3
Port Pi3 direction register
0 : Input mode
(Functions as an input port)
1 : Output mode
(Functions as an output port)
PDi_4
Port Pi4 direction register
(i = 0 to 12 except 3 and 7)
PDi_5
PDi_6
Port Pi5 direction register
Port Pi6 direction register
PDi_7
Port Pi7 direction register
Note : Do not access the Port P12 direction register in words.
Port P3 direction register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PD3
Bit symbol
Address
03E716
When reset
XX0000002
Bit name
PD3_0
Port P30 direction register
PD3_1
Port P31 direction register
PD3_2
Port P32 direction register
PD3_3
Port P33 direction register
PD3_4
PD3_5
Port P34 direction register
Port P35 direction register
Function
RW
0: Input mode
(Functions as an input port)
1: Output mode
(Functions as an output port)
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
Port P7 direction register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PD7
Bit symbol
PD7_0
Address
03EF16
When reset
X00000002
Bit name
Function
RW
Port P70 direction register
PD7_1
Port P71 direction register
PD7_2
Port P72 direction register
PD7_3
Port P73 direction register
PD7_4
PD7_5
Port P74 direction register
Port P75 direction register
PD7_6
Port P76 direction register
0: Input mode
(Functions as an input port)
1: Output mode
(Functions as an output port)
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
Port P13 direction register (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PD13
Bit symbol
PD13_0
PD13_1
PD13_2
Address
03FB16
Bit name
When reset
XXXXX0002
Function
RW
Port P130 direction register 0: Input mode
(Functions as an input port)
Port P131 direction register 1: Output mode
(Functions as an output port)
Port P132 direction register
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
Note : Do not access this register in words.
Figure 1.19.6. Direction register
147
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Programmable I/O Port
Port Pi register (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Pi ( = 0 to 12 except 3 and 7)
Bit symbol
Address
03E016, 03E116, 03E416, 03E816,
03E916, 03EC16, 03F016, 03F116,
03F416, 03F516, 03F816
Bit name
Pi_0
Port Pi0 register
Pi_1
Port Pi1 register
Pi_2
Port Pi2 register
Pi_3
Port Pi3 register
Pi_4
Pi_5
Port Pi4 register
Port Pi5 register
Pi_6
Port Pi6 register
Pi_7
Port Pi7 register
When reset
Indeterminate
Function
RW
Data is input an âtput to and
from each pin by reading and
writing to and from each
corresponding bit
0 : “L” level data
1 : “H” level data
(i = 0 to 12 except 3 and 7)
Note : Do not access the Port P12 register in words.
Port P3 register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
P3
Bit symbol
Address
03E516
When reset
Indeterminate
Bit mame
P3_0
Port P30 register
P3_1
Port P31 register
P3_2
Port P32 register
P3_3
Port P33 register
P3_4
P3_5
Port P34 register
Port P35 register
Function
R W
Data is input and output to and
from each pin by reading and
writing to and from each
corresponding bit
0 : “L” level data
1 : “H” level data
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
Port P7 register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
P7
b0
Bit symbol
Address
03ED16
When reset
Indeterminate
Bit mame
P7_0
Port P70 register
P7_1
P7_2
Port P71 register
Port P72 register
P7_3
Port P73 register
P7_4
Port P74 register
P7_5
Port P75 register
P7_6
Port P76 register
P7_7
Port P77 register
Function
RW
Data is input and output to and
from each pin by reading and
writing to and from each
corresponding bit
(except for P77)
0 : “L” level data
1 : “H” level data
Port P13 register (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
P13
Bit symbol
Address
03F916
When reset
Indeterminate
Bit mame
P13_0
Port P130 register
P13_1
Port P131 register
P13_2
Port P132 register
Function
Data is input and output to and
from each pin by reading and
writing to and from each
corresponding bit
0 : “L” level data
1 : “H” level data
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
Note : Do not access this Register in words.
Figure 1.19.7. Port register
148
RW
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Programmable I/O Port
Pull-up control register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR0
Bit symbol
Address
03FC16
Bit name
PU00
P00 to P03 pull-up
PU01
PU02
P04 to P07 pull-up
P10 to P13 pull-up
PU03
P14 to P17 pull-up
PU04
P20 to P23 pull-up
PU05
P24 to P27 pull-up
PU06
PU07
P30 to P33 pull-up
P34 to P37 pull-up
When reset
000000112
Function
RW
The corresponding port is pulled
high with a pull-up resistor
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high
Pull-up control register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR1
Bit symbol
Address
03FD16
Bit name
PU10
P40 to P43 pull-up
PU11
P44 to P47 pull-up
PU12
PU13
P50 to P53 pull-up
P54 to P57 pull-up
PU14
P60 to P63 pull-up
PU15
PU16
P64 to P67 pull-up
P70 to P73 pull-up
PU17
P74 to P77 pull-up
When reset
0016
Function
R W
The corresponding port is pulled
high with a pull-up resistor
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high
Pull-up control register 2
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR2
Bit symbol
Address
03FE16
Bit name
PU20
P80 to P83 pull-up
PU21
PU22
P84 to P87 pull-up
P90 to P93 pull-up
PU23
PU24
P94 to P97 pull-up
P100 to P103 pull-up
PU25
PU26
P104 to P107 pull-up
P110 to P113 pull-up
PU27
P114 to P117 pull-up
When reset
111100002
Function
RW
The corresponding port is pulled
high with a pull-up resistor
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high
Figure 1.19.8. Pull-up control register
149
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Programmable I/O Port
Key input mode register
AAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
KUPM
Bit
symbol
Address
012616
When reset
011000002
Bit name
Function
P1KIS
P1 key input select bit (Note1)
0 : Falling edge
1 : Two edges
P1KIE
P1 key input enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
P2KIS
P2 key input select bit (Note1)
0 : Falling edge
1 : Two edges
P2KIE
P2 key input enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
P3KIE
P3 key input enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
PUP12L
P120 to P123 pull-up (Note2)
PUP12H
P124 to P127 pull-up (Note2)
The corresponding port is
pulled high with a pull-up
resistor
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high
PUP13
P130 to P132 pull-up (Note2)
A
A
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
AA
A
A
A
A
A
A
AA
R W
Note 1 : If this bit is set for “Two edges” when the corresponding port has been
specified to have a pullup, the port is automatically pulled high intermittently.
Operating sub-clock.
Note 2 : The pull-up resistance is not connected for pins that are set for output from
peripheral functions, regardless of the setting in the pull-up control register.
Figure 1.19.9. Key input mode register
Real time port control register (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
RTP
Address
03FF16
Bit name
Bit symbol
RTP0
RTP1
RTP2
RTP3
When reset
0016
P00 to P03 real time port
mode select bit
P04 to P07 real time port
mode select bit
The corresponding ports of
output is controlled
0 : Ordinary port output
1 : Real time port output
P10 to P13 real time port
mode select bit
P14 to P17 real time port
mode select bit
RTP4
P20 to P23 real time port
mode select bit
RTP5
P24 to P27 real time port
mode select bit
P120 to P123 real time port
mode select bit
RTP6
Function
RTP7
P124 and P125 real time
port mode select bit
Note : The corresponding port direction register is invalidated.
Figure 1.19.10. Realtime port control register
150
R W
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Programmable I/O Port
Table 1.19.1. Example connection of unused pins in single-chip mode
Pin name
Connection
Ports P0 to P13
(excluding P77)
After setting for output mode, leave these pins open; or after setting for
input mode, connect every pin to VSS or VCC via a resistor.
XOUT (Note)
Open
NMI
Connect via resistor to VCC (pull-up)
AVCC
Connect to VCC
AVSS, VREF
Connect to VSS
C1, C2
Open
VL2, VL3
Connect to VCC
VL1
Connect to VSS
CNVSS
Connect to VSS
Note: With external clock input to XIN pin.
Microcomputer
Port P0 to P13 (except for P77)
(Input mode)
·
·
·
(Input mode)
(Output mode)
··
·
Open
NMI
VCC
AVCC
VL3
VL2
VL1
AVSS
VREF
CNVSS
VSS
Figure 1.19.11. Example connection of unused pins
151
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Usage precaution
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Usage Precaution
Timer A (timer mode)
(1) Reading the timer Ai register while a count is in progress allows reading, with arbitrary timing, the
value of the counter. Reading the timer Ai register with the reload timing gets “FFFF16”. Reading the
timer Ai register after setting a value in the timer Ai register with a count halted but before the counter
starts counting gets a proper value.
Timer A (event counter mode)
(1) Reading the timer Ai register while a count is in progress allows reading, with arbitrary timing, the
value of the counter. Reading the timer Ai register with the reload timing gets “FFFF16” by underflow
or “000016” by overflow. Reading the timer Ai register after setting a value in the timer Ai register with
a count halted but before the counter starts counting gets a proper value.
(2) When stop counting in free run type, set timer again.
Timer A (one-shot timer mode)
(1) Setting the count start flag to “0” while a count is in progress causes as follows:
• The counter stops counting and a content of reload register is reloaded.
• The TAiOUT pin outputs “L” level.
• The interrupt request generated and the timer Ai interrupt request bit goes to “1”.
(2) The timer Ai interrupt request bit goes to “1” if the timer's operation mode is set using any of the
following procedures:
• Selecting one-shot timer mode after reset.
• Changing operation mode from timer mode to one-shot timer mode.
• Changing operation mode from event counter mode to one-shot timer mode.
Therefore, to use timer Ai interrupt (interrupt request bit), set timer Ai interrupt request bit to “0”
after the above listed changes have been made.
Timer A (pulse width modulation mode)
(1) The timer Ai interrupt request bit becomes “1” if setting operation mode of the timer in compliance with
any of the following procedures:
• Selecting PWM mode after reset.
• Changing operation mode from timer mode to PWM mode.
• Changing operation mode from event counter mode to PWM mode.
Therefore, to use timer Ai interrupt (interrupt request bit), set timer Ai interrupt request bit to “0”
after the above listed changes have been made.
(2) Setting the count start flag to “0” while PWM pulses are being output causes the counter to stop
counting. If the TAiOUT pin is outputting an “H” level in this instance, the output level goes to “L”, and
the timer Ai interrupt request bit goes to “1”. If the TAiOUT pin is outputting an “L” level in this instance,
the level does not change, and the timer Ai interrupt request bit does not becomes “1”.
Timer B (timer mode, event counter mode)
(1) Reading the timer Bi register while a count is in progress allows reading , with arbitrary timing, the
value of the counter. Reading the timer Bi register with the reload timing gets “FFFF16”. Reading the
timer Bi register after setting a value in the timer Bi register with a count halted but before the counter
starts counting gets a proper value.
152
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Usage precaution
Timer B (pulse period/pulse width measurement mode)
(1) If changing the measurement mode select bit is set after a count is started, the timer Bi interrupt
request bit goes to “1”.
(2) When the first effective edge is input after a count is started, an indeterminate value is transferred to
the reload register. At this time, timer Bi interrupt request is not generated.
Real time port
(1) Make sure timer Ai for real time port output is set for timer mode, and is set to have “no gate function”
using the gate function select bit.
(2) Before setting the real time port mode select bit to “1”, temporarily turn off the timer Ai used and write
its set value to the timer Ai register.
A-D Converter
(1) Write to each bit (except bit 6) of A-D control register 0, to each bit of A-D control register 1, and to bit
0 of A-D control register 2 when A-D conversion is stopped (before a trigger occurs).
In particular, when the Vref connection bit is changed from “0” to “1”, start A-D conversion after an
elapse of 1 µs or longer.
(2) When changing A-D operation mode, select analog input pin again.
(3) Using one-shot mode or single sweep mode
Read the correspondence A-D register after confirming A-D conversion is finished. (It is known by AD conversion interrupt request bit.)
(4) Using repeat mode, repeat sweep mode 0 or repeat sweep mode 1
Use the undivided main clock as the internal CPU clock.
Stop Mode and Wait Mode
____________
(1) When returning from stop mode by hardware reset, RESET pin must be set to “L” level until main clock
oscillation is stabilized.
(2) When switching to either wait mode or stop mode, instructions occupying four bytes either from the
WAIT instruction or from the instruction that sets the every-clock stop bit to “1” within the instruction
queue are prefetched and then the program stops. So put at least four NOPs in succession either to
the WAIT instruction or to the instruction that sets the every-clock stop bit to “1”.
Interrupts
(1) Reading address 0000016
• When maskable interrupt is occurred, CPU read the interrupt information (the interrupt number
and interrupt request level) in the interrupt sequence.
The interrupt request bit of the certain interrupt written in address 0000016 will then be set to “0”.
Reading address 0000016 by software sets enabled highest priority interrupt source request bit to “0”.
Though the interrupt is generated, the interrupt routine may not be executed.
Do not read address 0000016 by software.
(2) Setting the stack pointer
• The value of the stack pointer immediately after reset is initialized to 000016. Accepting an
interrupt before setting a value in the stack pointer may become a factor of runaway. Be sure to
set a value in the stack pointer before accepting an interrupt.
_______
When using the NMI interrupt, initialize the stack point at the beginning of a program. Concerning
_______
the first instruction immediately after reset, generating any interrupts including the NMI interrupt is
prohibited.
153
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Usage precaution
_______
(3) The NMI interrupt
_______
_______
• The NMI interrupt can not be disabled. Be sure to connect NMI pin to Vcc via a pull-up resistor if
unused.
_______
• Do not get either into stop mode with the NMI pin set to “L”.
(4) External interrupt
• When the polarity of the INT0 to INT5 pins is changed, the interrupt request bit is sometimes set
to "1". After changing the polarity, set the interrupt request bit to "0".
(5) Rewrite the interrupt control register
• To rewrite the interrupt control register, do so at a point that does not generate the interrupt
request for that register. If there is possibility of the interrupt request occur, rewrite the interrupt
control register after the interrupt is disabled. The program examples are described as follow:
Example 1:
INT_SWITCH1:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
NOP
NOP
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Four NOP instructions are required when using HOLD function.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 2:
INT_SWITCH2:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
MOV.W MEM, R0
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Dummy read.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 3:
INT_SWITCH3:
PUSHC FLG
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
POPC FLG
; Push Flag register onto stack
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Enable interrupts.
The reason why two NOP instructions (four when using the HOLD function) or dummy read are inserted
before FSET I in Examples 1 and 2 is to prevent the interrupt enable flag I from being set before the
interrupt control register is rewritten due to effects of the instruction queue.
• When a instruction to rewrite the interrupt control register is executed but the interrupt is disabled,
the interrupt request bit is not set sometimes even if the interrupt request for that register has
been generated. This will depend on the instruction. If this creates problems, use the below instructions to change the register.
Instructions : AND, OR, BCLR, BSET
154
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Electrical characteristics
Table 1.21.1. Absolute maximum ratings
Parameter
Symbol
Vcc
AVcc
Supply voltage
Analog supply voltage
VI
Input
voltage
Condition
Rated value
Unit
Vcc=AVcc
– 0.3 to 6.5
Vcc=AVcc
– 0.3 to 6.5
V
V
– 0.3 to Vcc+0.3
V
RESET, VREF, XIN
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27,
P30 to P35, P40 to P47, P50 to P57,
P60 to P67, P72 to P77, P80 to P87,
P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,
P130 to P132
(Mask ROM version CNVss)
VL1
– 0.3 to VL2
VL2
VL1 to VL3
VL3
VL2 to 6.5
– 0.3 to 6.5
P70, P71, C1, C2
(flash memory version CNVss)
VO
Output
voltage
P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P35,
P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P60 to P67,
P72 to P76, P80 to P87, P90 to P97,
P130 to P132, XOUT
P00 to P07, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,
– 0.3 to Vcc+0.3
When output port
– 0.3 to Vcc
When segment output
– 0.3 to VL3
P70, P71
V
– 0.3 to 6.5
Pd
Power dissipation
Operating ambient temperature
300
– 20 to 85
mW
Topr
Tstg
Storage temperature
– 40 to 150
°C
Ta = 25°C
°C
155
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Electrical characteristics
Table 1.21.2. Recommended operating conditions (referenced to VCC = 2.7V to 5.5V at Ta = – 20 to 85oC
unless otherwise specified)
Symbol
Parameter
2.7
Vcc
Supply voltage
AVcc
Vss
Analog supply voltage
Analog supply voltage
Analog supply voltage
AVss
VIH
Min
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P35, P40 to P47,
P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P72 to P77, P80 to P87, P90 to P97,
P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127, 130 to P132,
XIN, RESET, CNVSS
HIGH input
voltage
P70, P71
VIL
IOH (peak) HIGH peak
output current
IOH (avg)
IOL (peak)
IOL (avg)
HIGH average
output current
(Note 1)
Vcc
0.8Vcc
6.5
0
0.2Vcc
P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P35, P40 to P47,
P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P70 to P76, P80 to P87, P90 to P97,
P130 to P132
VCC=4.0V to 5.5V
Main clock input
oscillation frequency
With wait
(Note 3)
f (XcIN)
V
–0.5
VCC=2.7V to 4.0V
V
V
mA
–10.0
–0.1
mA
–5.0
5.0
P00 to P07, P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127
P10 to P17, P20 to P27,P30 to P35, P40 to P47,
P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P70 to P76, P80 to P87, P90 to P97,
P130 to P132
P00 to P07, P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127
LOW average
output current
(Note 1)
V
0
P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P35, P40 to P47,
P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P72 to P76, P80 to P87, P90 to P97,
P130 to P132
LOW peak
output current
5.5
V
V
P00 to P07, P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127
P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P35, P40 to P47,
P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P72 to P76, P80 to P87, P90 to P97,
P130 to P132
P00 to P07, P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127
No wait
f (XIN)
5.0
Unit
Vcc
0
0.8Vcc
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P35, P40 to P47,
P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P70 to P77, P80 to P87, P90 to P97,
P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127, 130 to P132,
XIN, RESET, CNVSS
LOW input
voltage
Standard
Typ.
Max.
10.0
mA
2.5
mA
5.0
0
0
VCC=4.0V to 5.5V
0
VCC=2.7V to 4.0V
0
Subclock oscillation frequency
32.768
10
5 X VCC
–10.000
10
2.31 X VCC
+0.760
50
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
kHz
AAA
AAAA
AAA
AAAA
AAA AAAA
Main clock input oscillation frequency
(No wait)
10.0
5 X Vcc–10.000MHz
3.5
0.0
Main clock input oscillation frequency
(With wait)
10.0
2.31 X VCC+0.760MHz
7.0
0.0
2.7
4.0
Supply voltage [V]
(BCLK: no division)
156
Operating maximum frequency [MHZ]
Operating maximum frequency [MHZ]
Note 1: The mean output current is the mean value within 100ms.
Note 2: The total IOL (peak) for ports P0, P1, P2, P30 to P35, P4, P5, P6, P70 to P76 and P122 to P127 must be 80mA max. The total
IOH (peak) for ports P0, P1, P2, P30 to P35, P4, P5, P6, P72 to P76 and P122 to P127 must be 80mA max. The total IOL (peak)
for ports P8, P9, P10, P11, P120, P121 and P130 to P132 must be 80mA max. The total IOH (peak) for ports P8, P9, P10, P11,
P120,P121 and P130 to P132 must be 80mA max.
Note 3: Relationship between main clock oscillation frequency and supply voltage.
5.5
2.7
4.0
Supply voltage [V]
(BCLK: no division)
5.5
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Electrical characteristics (Vcc = 5V)
VCC = 5V
Table 1.21.3. Electrical characteristics (referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0V at Ta = 25oC, f(XIN)=10MHZ
unless otherwise specified)
Symbol
Measuring condition
Parameter
Standard
Min Typ. Max.
VOH
HIGH output P00 to P07, P100 to P107,
voltage
P110 to P117, P120 to P127
IOH= –0.1mA
3.0
VOH
HIGH output P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P35,
voltage
P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P60 to P67,
P72 to P76, P80 to P87, P90 to P97,
P130 to P132
I O H= – 5 m A
3.0
IOH= –200µA
4.7
VOH
VOH
VOL
VOL
VOL
VT+-VT-
I O H= – 1 m A
3.0
LOWPOWER
IOH= –0.5mA
3.0
HIGH output XCOUT
voltage
HIGHPOWER
With no load applied
3.0
LOWPOWER
With no load applied
1.6
LOW output XOUT
voltage
LOW output XCOUT
voltage
Hysteresis
IOL=5mA
V
2.0
IOL=200µA
2.0
LOWPOWER
IOH=0.5mA
2.0
HIGHPOWER
With no load applied
0
LOWPOWER
With no load applied
0
TA0IN to TA7IN, TB0IN to TB5IN,
INT0 to INT5, ADTRG, CTS0,
CTS1, CLK0, CLK1, NMI,
TA2OUT to TA4OUT, TA7OUT,
KI0 to KI15 (Note), KI16 to KI19
II H
HIGH input
current
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27,
P30 to P35, P40 to P47, P50 to P57,
P60 to P67, P70 to P77, P80 to P87,
P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,
P130 to P132, XIN, RESET, CNVSS
LOW input
current
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27,
P30 to P35, P40 to P47, P50 to P57,
P60 to P67, P70 to P77, P80 to P87,
P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,
P130 to P132, XIN, RESET, CNVSS
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27,
P30 to P35, P40 to P47, P50 to P57,
P60 to P67, P72 to P76, P80 to P87,
P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,
P130 to P132
V
0.45
IOH=1mA
RESET
Pull-up
resistance
V
HIGHPOWER
Hysteresis
RPULLUP
V
HIGHPOWER
VT+-VT-
II L
V
HIGH output XOUT
voltage
LOW output P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27,
voltage
P30 to P35, P40 to P47, P50 to P57,
P60 to P67, P70 to P76, P80 to P87,
P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,
P130 to P132
Unit
V
V
0.2
0.8
V
0.2
1.8
V
VI=5V
5.0
µA
VI=0V
–5.0
µA
167.0
kΩ
VI=0V
30.0
50.0
RfXIN
Feedback resistance
XIN
1.0
MΩ
RfXCIN
Feedback resistance
XCIN
6.0
MΩ
VRAM
RAM retention voltage
When clock is stopped
2.0
V
Note : Has no effect during intermittent pullup operation.
157
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Electrical characteristics (Vcc = 5V)
VCC = 5V
Table 1.21.4. Electrical characteristics (referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0V at Ta = 25oC, f(XIN)=10MHZ
unless otherwise specified)
Parameter
Symbol
Measuring condition
Min.
f(XIN)=10MHz
19.0
Square wave, no division
I/o pin is no
load applied
Mask ROM
version
f(XCIN)=32kHz
Square wave
Flash memory f(XCIN)=32kHz
version
Square wave
Power supply current
Icc
Standard
Typ. Max. Unit
f(XCIN)=32kHz
When a WAIT instruction is executed
90.0
mA
160.0
mA
4.0
mA
When clock is stopped
Ta=25 ºC
When clock is stopped
Ta=85 ºC
VL 1
Supply voltage (VL1)
When voltage multiplier used
IL1
Power supply current (VL1)
VL1=1.7V
mA
38.0
1.0
mA
20.0
1.3
1.7
2.1
V
3.0
TBD
mA
Table 1.21.5. A-D conversion characteristics (referenced to VCC = AVCC = VREF = 5V, Vss = AVSS = 0V
at Ta = 25oC, f(XIN) = 10MHZ unless otherwise specified)
Symbol
–
–
Parameter
VREF =VCC
Sample & hold function not available
VREF =VCC = 5V
10
±3
Bits
LSB
Sample & hold function available(10bit)
VREF =VCC= 5V
±3
LSB
Sample & hold function available(8bit)
VREF = VCC = 5V
±2
LSB
40
kW
VI A
Analog input voltage
tCONV
tSAMP
Unit
Absolute
accuracy
VREF
tCONV
Standard
Min. Typ. Max.
Resolution
Ladder resistance
Conversion time(10bit)
Conversion time(8bit)
Sampling time
Reference voltage
RLADDER
Measuring condition
VREF =VCC
10
ms
3.3
2.8
ms
0.3
2
ms
VCC
V
0
VREF
V
Table 1.21.6. D-A conversion characteristics (referenced to VCC = AVCC =VREF =5V, VSS = AVSS =
0V at Ta = 25oC, f(XIN) = 10MHZ unless otherwise specified)
Symbol
tsu
RO
IVREF
Parameter
Resolution
Absolute accuracy
Setup time
Output resistance
Reference power supply input current
Measuring condition
Standard
Typ. Max.
8
1.0
3
20
4
10
1.5
Min.
Unit
Bits
%
ms
kW
mA
(Note)
Note: This applies when using one D-A converter, with the D-A register for the unused D-A converter set to “0016”.
The A-D converter's ladder resistance is not included.
Also, when the Vref is unconnected at the A-D control register, IVREF is sent.
158
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Electrical characteristics (Vcc = 5V)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
VCC = 5V
Timing requirements (referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0V at Ta = 25oC unless otherwise specified)
Table 1.21.7. External clock input
Symbol
tc
tw(H)
tw(L)
tr
tf
Parameter
External clock input cycle time
External clock input HIGH pulse width
External clock input LOW pulse width
External clock rise time
External clock fall time
Standard
Min.
Max.
100
40
40
15
15
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 1.21.8. Timer A input (counter input in event counter mode)
Symbol
Parameter
tc(TA)
tw(TAH)
TAiIN input HIGH pulse width
tw(TAL)
TAiIN input LOW pulse width
TAiIN input cycle time
Standard
Min.
Max.
100
40
40
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 1.21.9. Timer A input (gating input in timer mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tc(TA)
TAiIN input cycle time
tw(TAH)
tw(TAL)
TAiIN input HIGH pulse width
TAiIN input LOW pulse width
Standard
Min.
Max.
400
200
200
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 1.21.10. Timer A input (external trigger input in one-shot timer mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tc(TA)
TAiIN input cycle time
tw(TAH)
tw(TAL)
TAiIN input HIGH pulse width
TAiIN input LOW pulse width
Standard
Min.
Max.
200
100
100
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 1.21.11. Timer A input (external trigger input in pulse width modulation mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tw(TAH)
tw(TAL)
TAiIN input HIGH pulse width
TAiIN input LOW pulse width
Standard
Min.
Max.
100
100
Unit
ns
ns
Table 1.21.12. Timer A input (up/down input in event counter mode)
Symbol
tc(UP)
tw(UPH)
tw(UPL)
tsu(UP-TIN)
th(TIN-UP)
Parameter
TAiOUT input cycle time
TAiOUT input HIGH pulse width
TAiOUT input LOW pulse width
TAiOUT input setup time
TAiOUT input hold time
Standard
Min.
Max.
2000
1000
1000
400
400
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
159
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Electrical characteristics (Vcc = 5V)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
VCC = 5V
Timing requirements (referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0V at Ta = 25oC unless otherwise specified)
Table 1.21.13. Timer B input (counter input in event counter mode)
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
TBiIN input cycle time (counted on one edge)
TBiIN input HIGH pulse width (counted on one edge)
100
40
ns
ns
tw(TBL)
TBiIN input LOW pulse width (counted on one edge)
TBiIN input cycle time (counted on both edges)
40
200
ns
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
TBiIN input HIGH pulse width (counted on both edges)
TBiIN input LOW pulse width (counted on both edges)
ns
ns
80
80
ns
Table 1.21.14. Timer B input (pulse period measurement mode)
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
tc(TB)
TBiIN input cycle time
400
ns
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
TBiIN input HIGH pulse width
TBiIN input LOW pulse width
200
200
ns
ns
Table 1.21.15. Timer B input (pulse width measurement mode)
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
tc(TB)
TBiIN input cycle time
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
TBiIN input HIGH pulse width
400
200
TBiIN input LOW pulse width
200
Max.
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 1.21.16. A-D trigger input
Symbol
tc(AD)
tw(ADL)
Parameter
ADTRG input cycle time (trigger able minimum)
ADTRG input LOW pulse width
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
1000
ns
125
ns
Table 1.21.17. Serial I/O
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
tc(CK)
CLKi input cycle time
200
ns
tw(CKH)
tw(CKL)
CLKi input HIGH pulse width
CLKi input LOW pulse width
100
100
ns
ns
td(C-Q)
TxDi output delay time
th(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
TxDi hold time
RxDi input setup time
th(C-D)
RxDi input hold time
80
0
30
90
ns
ns
ns
ns
_______
Table 1.21.18. External interrupt INTi inputs
Symbol
160
Parameter
tw(INH)
INTi input HIGH pulse width
tw(INL)
INTi input LOW pulse width
Standard
Min.
Max.
250
250
Unit
ns
ns
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timing
P0
P1
P2
P3
30pF
P4
P5
P6
P7
P8
P9
P10
P11
P12
P13
Figure 1.21.1. Port P0 to P13 measurement circuit
161
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timing (VCC = 5V)
VCC = 5V
tc(TA)
tw(TAH)
TAiIN input
tw(TAL)
tc(UP)
tw(UPH)
TAiOUT input
tw(UPL)
TAiOUT input
(Up/down input)
During event counter mode
TAiIN input
tsu(UP–TIN)
th(TIN–UP)
(When count on falling
edge is selected)
TAiIN input
(When count on rising
edge is selected)
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
TBiIN input
tw(TBL)
tc(AD)
ADTRG input
tw(ADL)
tc(CK)
tw(CKH)
CLKi
tw(CKL)
th(C–Q)
TxDi
td(C–Q)
RxDi
tw(INL)
INTi input
tw(INH)
162
tsu(D–C)
th(C–D)
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Electrical characteristics (Vcc = 3V)
VCC = 3V
Table 1.21.19. Electrical characteristics (referenced to VCC = 3V, VSS = 0V at Ta = 25oC, f(XIN) =
7MHZ, with wait)
Standard
Symbol
Parameter
Measuring condition
Min Typ. Max. Unit
VOH
HIGH output P00 to P07, P100 to P107,
voltage
P110 to P117, P120 to P127
IOH= –20µA
2.0
V
VOH
HIGH output P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P35,
voltage
P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P60 to P67,
P72 to P76, P80 to P87, P90 to P97,
P130 to P132
I O H= – 1 m A
2.5
V
VOH
HIGH output XOUT
voltage
HIGHPOWER
IOH= –0.1mA
2.5
LOWPOWER
IOH= –50µA
2.5
HIGHPOWER
With no load applied
3.0
LOWPOWER
With no load applied
1.6
VOH
HIGH output XCOUT
voltage
VOL
LOW output P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27,
voltage
P30 to P35, P40 to P47, P50 to P57,
P60 to P67, P70 to P76, P80 to P87,
P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,
P130 to P132
VOL
LOW output
voltage
XOUT
LOW output
voltage
XCOUT
VOL
0.5
HIGHPOWER
IOH=0.1mA
0.5
LOWPOWER
IOH=50µA
0.5
HIGHPOWER
With no load applied
0
LOWPOWER
With no load applied
0
TA0IN to TA7IN, TB0IN to TB5IN,
INT0 to INT5, ADTRG, CTS0,
CTS1, CLK0, CLK1, NMI,
TA2OUT to TA4OUT, TA7OUT,
KI0 to KI15 (Note), KI16 to KI19
Hysteresis
VT+-VT-
Hysteresis
II H
HIGH input P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27,
current
P30 to P35, P40 to P47, P50 to P57,
P60 to P67, P70 to P77, P80 to P87,
P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,
P130 to P132, XIN, RESET, CNVSS
RPULLUP
LOW input
current
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27,
P30 to P35, P40 to P47, P50 to P57,
P60 to P67, P70 to P77, P80 to P87,
P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,
P130 to P132, XIN, RESET, CNVSS
Pull-up
resistance
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27,
P30 to P35, P40 to P47, P50 to P57,
P60 to P67, P72 to P76, P80 to P87,
P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,
P130 to P132
Feedback resistance
XIN
RfXCIN
Feedback resistance
XCIN
VRAM
RAM retention voltage
V
V
V
0.2
0.8
V
0.2
1.8
V
VI=3V
4.0
µA
VI=0V
–4.0
µA
TBD
kΩ
RESET
RfXIN
V
IOL=1mA
VT+-VT-
II L
V
VI=0V
When clock is stopped
TBD 120.0
2.0
3.0
MΩ
10.0
MΩ
V
Note : Has no effect during intermittent pullup operation.
163
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Electrical characteristics (Vcc = 3V)
VCC = 3V
Table 1.21.20. Electrical characteristics (referenced to VCC = 3V, VSS = 0V at Ta = 25oC, f(XIN) =
7MHZ, with wait)
Parameter
Symbol
Measuring condition
Min.
f(XIN)=7MHz
6.0
Square wave, no division
I/o pin is no
load applied
Mask ROM
version
f(XCIN)=32kHz
Square wave
Flash memory f(XCIN)=32kHz
version
Square wave
Power supply current
Icc
Standard
Typ. Max.
f(XCIN)=32kHz
When a WAIT instruction is executed
Oscillation capacity High (Note)
15.0
Unit
mA
40.0
µA
110.0
µA
2.8
µA
0.9
µA
f(XCIN)=32kHz
When a WAIT instruction is executed
Oscillation capacity Low (Note)
When clock is stopped
Ta=25 ºC
When clock is stopped
Ta=85 ºC
VL1
Supply voltage (VL1)
When voltage multiplier used
IL1
Power supply current (VL1)
VL1=1.7V
1.0
µA
20.0
1.3
1.7
2.1
V
3.0
TBD
µA
Note: With one timer operated using fC32.
Table 1.21.21. A-D conversion characteristics (referenced to VCC = AVCC = VREF = 3V, VSS = AVSS =
0V at Ta = 25oC, f(XIN) = 7MHZ, with wait unless otherwise specified)
Symbol
–
–
Parameter
RLADDER
tCONV
VREF
VIA
Standard
Min. Typ. Max.
Bits
±2
LSB
10
40
14.0
2.7
0
VCC
VREF
kW
ms
V
V
Sample & hold function not available(8bit) VREF =VCC = 3V, øAD=fAD/2
Ladder resistance
Conversion time(8bit)
Reference voltage
Analog input voltage
VREF =VCC
Unit
10
VREF =VCC
Resolution
Absolute
accuracy
Measuring condition
Table 1.21.22. D-A conversion characteristics (referenced to VCC = AVCC= VREF= 3V, VSS = AVSS =
0V, at Ta = 25oC, f(XIN) = 7MHZ unless otherwise specified)
Symbol
tsu
RO
IVREF
Parameter
Resolution
Absolute accuracy
Setup time
Output resistance
Reference power supply input current
Measuring condition
(Note)
Standard
Typ. Max.
8
1.0
3
20
4
10
1.0
Min.
Unit
Bits
%
µs
kΩ
mA
Note : This applies when using one D-A converter, with the D-A register for the unused D-A converter set to “0016”. The
A-D converter's ladder resistance is not included.
Also, when the Vref is unconnected at the A-D control register, IVREF is sent.
164
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Electrical characteristics (Vcc = 3V)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
VCC = 3V
Timing requirements (referenced to VCC = 3V, VSS = 0V at Ta = 25oC unless otherwise specified)
Table 1.21.23. External clock input
Symbol
tc
tw(H)
tw(L)
tr
tf
Parameter
External clock input cycle time
External clock input HIGH pulse width
External clock input LOW pulse width
External clock rise time
External clock fall time
Standard
Min.
Max.
143
60
60
18
18
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 1.21.24. Timer A input (counter input in event counter mode)
Symbol
Parameter
tc(TA)
tw(TAH)
TAiIN input HIGH pulse width
tw(TAL)
TAiIN input LOW pulse width
TAiIN input cycle time
Standard
Max.
Min.
150
60
60
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 1.21.25. Timer A input (gating input in timer mode)
Symbol
tc(TA)
tw(TAH)
tw(TAL)
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
TAiIN input cycle time
600
ns
TAiIN input HIGH pulse width
TAiIN input LOW pulse width
300
300
ns
ns
Table 1.21.26. Timer A input (external trigger input in one-shot timer mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tc(TA)
TAiIN input cycle time
tw(TAH)
TAiIN input HIGH pulse width
TAiIN input LOW pulse width
tw(TAL)
Standard
Min.
Max.
300
150
150
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 1.21.27. Timer A input (external trigger input in pulse width modulation mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tw(TAH)
tw(TAL)
TAiIN input HIGH pulse width
TAiIN input LOW pulse width
Standard
Min.
Max.
150
150
Unit
ns
ns
Table 1.21.28. Timer A input (up/down input in event counter mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tc(UP)
tw(UPH)
TAiOUT input cycle time
tw(UPL)
tsu(UP-TIN)
TAiOUT input LOW pulse width
TAiOUT input setup time
TAiOUT input hold time
th(TIN-UP)
TAiOUT input HIGH pulse width
Standard
Min.
Max.
3000
1500
1500
600
600
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
165
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Electrical characteristics (Vcc = 3V)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
VCC = 3V
Timing requirements (referenced to VCC = 3V, VSS = 0V at Ta = 25oC unless otherwise specified)
Table 1.21.29. Timer B input (counter input in event counter mode)
Symbol
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
TBiIN input cycle time (counted on one edge)
TBiIN input HIGH pulse width (counted on one edge)
150
ns
60
TBiIN input LOW pulse width (counted on one edge)
TBiIN input cycle time (counted on both edges)
60
300
ns
ns
TBiIN input HIGH pulse width (counted on both edges)
TBiIN input LOW pulse width (counted on both edges)
160
160
ns
ns
ns
Table 1.21.30. Timer B input (pulse period measurement mode)
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
tc(TB)
TBiIN input cycle time
600
ns
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
TBiIN input HIGH pulse width
TBiIN input LOW pulse width
300
300
ns
ns
Table 1.21.31. Timer B input (pulse width measurement mode)
Symbol
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
TBiIN input cycle time
TBiIN input HIGH pulse width
600
ns
300
TBiIN input LOW pulse width
300
ns
ns
Table 1.21.32. A-D trigger input
Symbol
tc(AD)
tw(ADL)
Parameter
ADTRG input cycle time (trigger able minimum)
ADTRG input LOW pulse width
Standard
Max.
Min.
Unit
1500
ns
200
ns
Table 1.21.33. Serial I/O
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
CLKi input cycle time
300
ns
tw(CKH)
CLKi input HIGH pulse width
CLKi input LOW pulse width
TxDi output delay time
150
150
ns
tw(CKL)
td(C-Q)
th(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
TxDi hold time
RxDi input setup time
th(C-D)
RxDi input hold time
tc(CK)
160
0
50
90
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
_______
Table 1.21.34. External interrupt INTi inputs
Symbol
166
Parameter
tw(INH)
INTi input HIGH pulse width
tw(INL)
INTi input LOW pulse width
Standard
Max.
Min.
380
380
Unit
ns
ns
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Timing (Vcc = 3V)
VCC = 3V
tc(TA)
tw(TAH)
TAiIN input
tw(TAL)
tc(UP)
tw(UPH)
TAiOUT input
tw(UPL)
TAiOUT input
(Up/down input)
During event counter mode
TAiIN input
(When count on falling
edge is selected)
tsu(UP–TIN)
th(TIN–UP)
TAiIN input
(When count on rising
edge is selected)
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
TBiIN input
tw(TBL)
tc(AD)
tw(ADL)
ADTRG input
tc(CK)
tw(CKH)
CLKi
tw(CKL)
th(C–Q)
TxDi
td(C–Q)
tsu(D–C)
RxDi
INTi input
th(C–D)
tw(INL)
tw(INH)
167
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Description (Flash Memory Version)
Outline Performance
Table 1.22.1 shows the outline performance of the M30220 (flash memory version).
Table 1.22.1. Outline performance of the M30220 (flash memory version)
Item
Performance
Power supply voltage
2.7V to 5.5 V (f(XIN)=10MHz, without wait, 4.0V to 5.5V,
f(XIN)=7MHz, with one wait, 2.7V to 5.5V)
Program/erase voltage
4.5V to 5.5 V (f(XIN)=10.0MHz, with one wait,
f(XIN)=5.0MHz, without wait)
Flash memory operation mode
Three modes (parallel I/O, standard serial I/O, CPU rewrite)
Erase block
division
User ROM area
See Figure 1.22.1
Boot ROM area
No division (8 K bytes) (Note)
Program method
In units of words
Erase method
Collective erase/block erase
Program/erase control method
Program/erase control by software command
Number of commands
6 commands
Program/erase count
100 times
ROM code protect
Parallel I/O and standard serial modes are supported.
Note: The boot ROM area contains a standard serial I/O mode control program which is stored in it when
shipped from the factory. This area can be erased and programmed in only parallel I/O mode.
168
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Description (Flash Memory Version)
Flash Memory
The M30220 (flash memory version) has an internal new DINOR (DIvided bit line NOR) flash memory that
can be rewritten with a single power source when VCC is 5 V, and 2 power sources when VCC is 3.3 V.
For this flash memory, three flash memory modes are available in which to read, program, and erase:
parallel I/O and standard serial I/O modes in which the flash memory can be manipulated using a programmer and a CPU rewrite mode in which the flash memory can be manipulated by the Central Processing Unit
(CPU). Each mode is detailed in the pages to follow.
The flash memory is divided into several blocks as shown in Figure 1.22.1, so that memory can be erased
one block at a time.
In addition to the ordinary user ROM area to store a microcomputer operation control program, the flash
memory has a boot ROM area that is used to store a program to control rewriting in CPU rewrite and
standard serial I/O modes. This boot ROM area has had a standard serial I/O mode control program stored
in it when shipped from the factory. However, the user can write a rewrite control program in this area that
suits the user’s application system. This boot ROM area can be rewritten in only parallel I/O mode.
Parallel I/O mode
0E000016
0E800016
0F000016
0F800016
Block 4 : 32K byte
Block 3 : 32K byte
Block 2 : 32K byte
Block 1 : 32K byte
0DE00016
0DFFFF16
0FFFFF16
User ROM area
8K byte
Boot ROM area
CPU rewrite mode, standard serial I/O mode
0DE00016
0DFFFF16
0E000016
Boot ROM area
0E800016
Block 3 : 32K byte
8K byte
Block 4 : 32K byte
User ROM area
0F000016
Flash memory
size
128K
byte
Flash memory
start address
0F800016
Block 2 : 32K byte
Block 1 : 32K byte
0E000016
Note 1: The boot ROM area can be rewritten in only parallel input/
output mode. (Access to any other areas is inhibited.)
Note 2: To specify a block, use the maximum address in the block
that is an even address.
0FFFFF16
Figure 1.22.1. Block diagram of flash memory version
169
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
CPU Rewrite Mode (Flash Memory Version)
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
CPU Rewrite Mode
In CPU rewrite mode, the on-chip flash memory can be operated on (read, program, or erase) under control
of the Central Processing Unit (CPU).
In CPU rewrite mode, only the user ROM area shown in Figure 1.22.1 can be rewritten; the boot ROM area
cannot be rewritten. Make sure the program and block erase commands are issued for only the user ROM
area and each block area.
The control program for CPU rewrite mode can be stored in either user ROM or boot ROM area. In the CPU
rewrite mode, because the flash memory cannot be read from the CPU, the rewrite control program must
be transferred to any area other than the internal flash memory before it can be executed.
Microcomputer Mode and Boot Mode
The control program for CPU rewrite mode must be written into the user ROM or boot ROM area in
parallel I/O mode beforehand. (If the control program is written into the boot ROM area, the standard
serial I/O mode becomes unusable.)
See Figure 1.22.1 for details about the boot ROM area.
Normal microcomputer mode is entered when the microcomputer is reset with pulling CNVSS pin low. In
this case, the CPU starts operating using the control program in the user ROM area.
When the microcomputer is reset by pulling the P74 pin high, the CNVSS pin high, the CPU starts operating using the control program in the boot ROM area (program start address is DE00016 fixation). This
mode is called the “boot” mode.
Block Address
Block addresses refer to the maximum even address of each block. These addresses are used in the
block erase command.
170
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
CPU Rewrite Mode (Flash Memory Version)
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Outline Performance (CPU Rewrite Mode)
In the CPU rewrite mode, the CPU erases, programs and reads the internal flash memory as instructed by
software commands. This rewrite control program must be transferred to internal RAM before it can be
excuted.
The CPU rewrite mode is accessed by applying 5V ± 10% to the CNVSS pin and writing “1” for the CPU
rewrite mode select bit (bit 1 in address 03B416). Software commands are accepted once the mode is
accessed.
In the CPU rewrite mode, write to and read from software commands and data into even-numbered address (“0” for byte address A0) in 16-bit units. Always write 8-bit software commands into even-numbered
address. Commands are ignored with odd-numbered addresses.
Use software commands to control program and erase operations. Whether a program or erase operation
has terminated normally or in error can be verified by reading the status register.
Figure 1.23.1 shows the flash memory control register.
_____
Bit 0 is the RY/BY status flag used exclusively to read the operating status of the flash memory. During
programming and erase operations, it is “0”. Otherwise, it is “1”.
Bit 1 is the CPU rewrite mode select bit. When this bit is set to “1” and 5V ± 10% are applied to the CNVSS
pin, the M30220 accesses the CPU rewrite mode. Software commands are accepted once the mode is
accessed. In CPU rewrite mode, the CPU becomes unable to access the internal flash memory directly.
Therefore, use the control program in RAM for write to bit 1. To set this bit to “1”, it is necessary to write “0”
and then write “1” in succession. The bit can be set to “0” by only writing a “0” .
Bit 2 is the CPU rewrite mode entry flag. This bit can be read to check whether the CPU rewrite mode has
been entered or not.
Bit 3 is the flash memory reset bit used to reset the control circuit of the internal flash memory. This bit is
used when exiting CPU rewrite mode and when flash memory access has failed. When the CPU rewrite
mode select bit is “1”, writing “1” for this bit resets the control circuit. To release the reset, it is necessary to
set this bit to “0”. If the control circuit is reset while erasing is in progress, a 5 ms wait is needed so that the
flash memory can restore normal operation. Figure 1.23.2 shows a flowchart for setting/releasing the CPU
rewrite mode.
171
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
CPU Rewrite Mode (Flash Memory Version)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Flash memory control register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
Address
When reset
FMCR
03B416
XXXX00012
Bit symbol
Bit name
Function
A
AA
A
AA
FMCR0
RY/BY status flag
0: Busy (being written or erased)
1: Ready
FMCR1
CPU rewrite mode
select bit (Note 1)
0: Normal mode
(Software commands invalid)
1: CPU rewrite mode
FMCR2
CPU rewrite mode
entry flag
0: Normal mode
(Software commands invalid)
1: CPU rewrite mode
(Software commands acceptable)
FMCR3
Flash memory reset bit
(Note 2)
0: Normal operation
1: Reset
Nothing is assigned.
When write, set "0". When read, values are indeterminate.
R WW
R
Note 1: For this bit to be set to “1”, the user needs to write a “0” and then a “1” to it in
succession. When it is not this procedure, it is not enacted in “1”. This is necessary to
ensure that no interrupt or DMA transfer will be executed during the interval. Use the
control program in the RAM for write to this bit.
Note 2: Effective only when the CPU rewrite mode select bit = 1. Set this bit to 0 subsequently
after setting it to 1 (reset).
Figure 1.23.1. Flash memory control registers
172
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
CPU Rewrite Mode (Flash Memory Version)
Program in ROM
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Program in RAM
Start
*1
Single-chip mode, or boot mode (Note 1)
Set CPU rewrite mode select bit to “1” (by
writing “0” and then “1” in succession)(Note 3)
Set processor mode register (Note 2)
Check the CPU rewrite mode entry flag
Transfer CPU rewrite mode control
program to internal RAM
Jump to transferred control program in RAM
(Subsequent operations are executed by control
program in this RAM)
Using software command execute erase,
program, or other operation
Execute read array command or reset flash
memory by setting flash memory reset bit (by
writing “1” and then “0” in succession) (Note 4)
*1
Write “0” to CPU rewrite mode select bit
End
Note 1: Apply 5V ± 10 % to CNVSS pin by confirmation of CPU rewrite mode entry flag when started operation
with single-chip mode.
Note 2: During CPU rewrite mode, set the main clock frequency as shown below using the main clock divide ratio
select bit (bit 6 at address 000616 and bits 6 and 7 at address 000716):
5.0 MHz or less when wait bit (bit 7 at address 000516) = “0” (without internal access wait state)
10.0 MHz or less when wait bit (bit 7 at address 000516) = “1” (with internal access wait state)
Note 3: For CPU rewrite mode select bit to be set to “1”, the user needs to write a “0” and then a “1” to it in
succession. When it is not this procedure, it is not enacted in “1”. This is necessary to ensure that no
interrupt or DMA transfer will be executed during the interval.
Note 4: Before exiting the CPU rewrite mode after completing erase or program operation, always be sure to
execute a read array command or reset the flash memory.
Figure 1.23.2. CPU rewrite mode set/reset flowchart
173
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
CPU Rewrite Mode (Flash Memory Version)
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Precautions on CPU Rewrite Mode
Described below are the precautions to be observed when rewriting the flash memory in CPU rewrite
mode.
(1) Operation speed
During CPU rewrite mode, set the main clock frequency as shown below using the main clock divide
ratio select bit (bit 6 at address 000616 and bits 6 and 7 at address 000716):
5.0 MHz or less when wait bit (bit 7 at address 000516) = 0 (without internal access wait state)
10.0 MHz or less when wait bit (bit 7 at address 000516) = 1 (with internal access wait state)
(2) Instructions inhibited against use
The instructions listed below cannot be used during CPU rewrite mode because they refer to the
internal data of the flash memory:
UND instruction, INTO instruction, JMPS instruction, JSRS instruction, and BRK instruction
(3) Interrupts inhibited against use
_______
The NMI, address match, and watchdog timer interrupts cannot be used during CPU rewrite mode
because they refer to the internal data of the flash memory. If interrupts have their vector in the variable vector table, they can be used by transferring the vector into the RAM area.
(4) Reset
If the control circuit is reset while erasing is in progress, a 5 ms wait is needed so that the flash
memory can restore normal operation. Set a 5 ms wait to release the reset operation.
Also, when the reset has been released, the program execute start address is automatically set to
0DE00016, therefore program so that the execute start address of the boot ROM is 0DE00016.
174
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
CPU Rewrite Mode (Flash Memory Version)
Software Commands
Table 1.23.1 lists the software commands available with the M30220 (flash memory version).
After setting the CPU rewrite mode select bit to 1, write a software command to specify an erase or
program operation. Note that when entering a software command, the upper byte (D8 to D15) is ignored.
The content of each software command is explained below.
Table 1.23.1. List of software commands (CPU rewrite mode)
First bus cycle
Command
Cycle number
Second bus cycle
Mode
Data
Address (D0 to D7)
X
Mode
Address
Read
X
Read array
1
Write
Read status register
2
Write
X
Clear status register
1
Write
X
5016
Program
2
Write
X
4016
Write
Erase all block
2
Write
X
2016
Write
Block erase
2
Write
X
2016
Write
(Note 3)
(Note 5)
Data
(D0 to D7)
FF16
7016
WA
(Note 3)
X
BA
(Note 4)
SRD
(Note 2)
WD
(Note 3)
2016
D016
Note 1: When a software command is input, the high-order byte of data (D8 to D15) is ignored.
Note 2: SRD = Status Register Data
Note 3: WA = Write Address, WD = Write Data
Note 4: BA = Block Address (Enter the maximum address of each block that is an even address.)
Note 5: X denotes a given address in the user ROM area (that is an even address).
Read Array Command (FF16)
The read array mode is entered by writing the command code “FF16” in the first bus cycle. When an
even address to be read is input in one of the bus cycles that follow, the content of the specified
address is read out at the data bus (D0–D15), 16 bits at a time.
The read array mode is retained intact until another command is written.
Read Status Register Command (7016)
When the command code “7016” is written in the first bus cycle, the content of the status register is
read out at the data bus (D0–D7) by a read in the second bus cycle.
The status register is explained in the next section.
Clear Status Register Command (5016)
This command is used to clear the bits SR4 to SR5 of the status register after they have been set.
These bits indicate that operation has ended in an error. To use this command, write the command
code “5016” in the first bus cycle.
175
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
CPU Rewrite Mode (Flash Memory Version)
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Program Command (4016)
Program operation starts when the command code “4016” is written in the first bus cycle. Then, if the
address and data to program are written in the 2nd bus cycle, program operation (data programming
and verification) will start.
Whether the write operation is completed can be confirmed by reading the status register or the RY/
_____
BY status flag. When the program starts, the read status register mode is accessed automatically and
the content of the status register is read into the data bus (D0 - D7). The status register bit 7 (SR7) is
set to 0 at the same time the write operation starts and is returned to 1 upon completion of the write
operation. In this case, the read status register mode remains active until the Read Array command
(FF16) is written.
____
The RY/BY status flag is 0 during write operation and 1 when the write operation is completed as is
the status register bit 7.
At program end, program results can be checked by reading the status register.
Erase All Blocks Command (2016/2016)
By writing the command code “2016” in the first bus cycle and the confirmation command code “2016”
in the second bus cycle that follows, the system starts erase all blocks( erase and erase verify).
Whether the erase all blocks command is terminated can be confirmed by reading the status register
____
or the RY/BY status flag. When the erase all blocks operation starts, the read status register mode is
accessed automatically and the content of the status register can be read out. The status register bit
7 (SR7) is set to 0 at the same time the erase operation starts and is returned to 1 upon completion of
the erase operation. In this case, the read status register mode remains active until the Read Array
command (FF16) is written.
Start
Write 4016
Write Write address
Write data
Status register
read
SR7=1?
or
RY/BY=1?
NO
YES
NO
SR4=0?
YES
Program
completed
Figure 1.23.3. Program flowchart
176
Program
error
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
CPU Rewrite Mode (Flash Memory Version)
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
____
The RY/BY status flag is 0 during erase operation and 1 when the erase operation is completed as is
the status register bit 7.
At erase all blocks end, erase results can be checked by reading the status register. For details, refer
to the section where the status register is detailed.
Block Erase Command (2016/D016)
By writing the command code “2016” in the first bus cycle and the confirmation command code “D016”
in the second bus cycle that follows to the block address of a flash memory block, the system initiates
a block erase (erase and erase verify) operation.
Whether the block erase operation is completed can be confirmed by reading the status register or
____
the RY/BY status flag. At the same time the block erase operation starts, the read status register
mode is automatically entered, so the content of the status register can be read out. The status
register bit 7 (SR7) is set to 0 at the same time the block erase operation starts and is returned to 1
upon completion of the block erase operation. In this case, the read status register mode remains
active until the Read Array command (FF16).
____
The RY/BY status flag is 0 during block erase operation and 1 when the block erase operation is
completed as is the status register bit 7.
After the block erase operation is completed, the status register can be read out to know the result of
the block erase operation. For details, refer to the section where the status register is detailed.
Start
Write 2016
Write
2016:Erase all blocks
D016:Block erase
2016/D016
Block address
Status register
read
SR7=1?
or
RY/BY=1?
NO
YES
SR5=0?
NO
Erase error
YES
Erase completed
Figure 1.23.4. Erase flowchart
177
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
CPU Rewrite Mode (Flash Memory Version)
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Status Register
The status register shows the operating state of the flash memory and whether erase operations and
programs ended successfully or in error. It can be read in the following ways.
(1) By reading an arbitrary address from the user ROM area after writing the read status register
command (7016)
(2) By reading an arbitrary address from the user ROM area in the period from when the program starts
or erase operation starts to when the read array command (FF16) is input
Table 1.23.2 shows the status register.
Also, the status register can be cleared in the following way.
(1) By writing the clear status register command (5016)
After a reset, the status register is set to “8016”.
Each bit in this register is explained below.
Sequencer status (SR7)
After power-on, the sequencer status is set to 1(ready).
The sequencer status indicates the operating status of the device. This status bit is set to 0 (busy)
during write or erase operation and is set to 1 upon completion of these operations.
Erase status (SR5)
The erase status informs the operating status of erase operation to the CPU. When an erase error
occurs, it is set to 1.
The erase status is reset to 0 when cleared.
Program status (SR4)
The program status informs the operating status of write operation to the CPU. When a write error
occurs, it is set to 1.
The program status is reset to 0 when cleared.
If “1” is written for any of the SR5 or SR4 bits, the program, erase all blocks, and block erase commands are not accepted. Before executing these commands, execute the clear status register command (5016) and clear the status register.
Also, any commands are not correct, both SR5 and SR4 are set to 1.
178
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
CPU Rewrite Mode (Flash Memory Version)
Table 1.23.2. Definition of each bit in status register
Definition
Each bit of
SRD
Status name
"1"
"0"
Ready
Busy
-
-
SR7 (bit7)
Sequencer status
SR6 (bit6)
Reserved
SR5 (bit5)
Erase status
Terminated in error
Terminated normally
SR4 (bit4)
Program status
Terminated in error
Terminated normally
SR3 (bit3)
Reserved
-
-
SR2 (bit2)
Reserved
-
-
SR1 (bit1)
Reserved
-
-
SR0 (bit0)
Reserved
-
-
Full Status Check
By performing full status check, it is possible to know the execution results of erase and program
operations. Figure 1.23.5 shows a full status check flowchart and the action to be taken when each
error occurs.
Read status register
YES
SR4=1 and SR5
=1 ?
Command
sequence error
NO
SR5=0?
NO
Block erase error
Execute the clear status register command (5016)
to clear the status register. Try performing the
operation one more time after confirming that the
command is entered correctly.
Should a block erase error occur, the block in error
cannot be used.
YES
SR4=0?
NO
Program error
Should a program error occur, the block in error
cannot be used.
YES
End (block erase, program)
Note: When one of SR5 to SR4 is set to 1, none of the program, erase all blocks, and
block erase commands is accepted. Execute the clear status register command
(5016) before executing these commands.
Figure 1.23.5. Full status check flowchart and remedial procedure for errors
179
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Functions To Inhibit Rewriting Flash Memory Version (Flash Memory Version)
Functions To Inhibit Rewriting Flash Memory Version
To prevent the contents of the flash memory version from being read out or rewritten easily, the device
incorporates a ROM code protect function for use in parallel I/O mode and an ID code check function for
use in standard serial I/O mode.
ROM code protect function
The ROM code protect function reading out or modifying the contents of the flash memory version by
using the ROM code protect control address (0FFFFF16) during parallel I/O mode. Figure 1.23.6 shows
the ROM code protect control address (0FFFFF16). (This address exists in the user ROM area.)
If one of the pair of ROM code protect bits is set to 0, ROM code protect is turned on, so that the contents
of the flash memory version are protected against readout and modification. ROM code protect is implemented in two levels. If level 2 is selected, the flash memory is protected even against readout by a
shipment inspection LSI tester, etc. When an attempt is made to select both level 1 and level 2, level 2 is
selected by default.
If both of the two ROM code protect reset bits are set to “00,” ROM code protect is turned off, so that the
contents of the flash memory version can be read out or modified. Once ROM code protect is turned on,
the contents of the ROM code protect reset bits cannot be modified in parallel I/O mode. Use the serial I/
O or some other mode to rewrite the contents of the ROM code protect reset bits.
ROM code protect control address
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 1
Symbol
ROMCP
Address
0FFFFF16
When reset
FF16
Bit name
Bit symbol
Reserved bit
Function
Always set this bit to 1.
ROM code protect level
2 set bit (Note 1, 2)
b3 b2
ROMCP2
ROM code protect reset
bit (Note 3)
b5 b4
ROMCR
ROMCP1
ROM code protect level
1 set bit (Note 1)
b7 b6
00: Protect enabled
01: Protect enabled
10: Protect enabled
11: Protect disabled
00: Protect removed
01: Protect set bit effective
10: Protect set bit effective
11: Protect set bit effective
00: Protect enabled
01: Protect enabled
10: Protect enabled
11: Protect disabled
Note 1: When ROM code protect is turned on, the on-chip flash memory is protected against
readout or modification in parallel input/output mode.
Note 2: When ROM code protect level 2 is turned on, ROM code readout by a shipment
inspection LSI tester, etc. also is inhibited.
Note 3: The ROM code protect reset bits can be used to turn off ROM code protect level 1 and
ROM code protect level 2. However, since these bits cannot be changed in parallel input/
output mode, they need to be rewritten in serial input/output or some other mode.
Figure 1.23.6. ROM code protect control address
180
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Functions To Inhibit Rewriting Flash Memory Version (Flash Memory Version)
ID Code Check Function
Use this function in standard serial I/O mode. When the contents of the flash memory are not blank, the ID
code sent from the peripheral unit is compared with the ID code written in the flash memory to see if they
match. If the ID codes do not match, the commands sent from the peripheral unit are not accepted. The ID
code consists of 8-bit data, the areas of which, beginning with the first byte, are 0FFFDF16, 0FFFE316,
0FFFEB16, 0FFFEF16, 0FFFF316, 0FFFF716, and 0FFFFB16. Write a program which has had the ID code
preset at these addresses to the flash memory.
Address
0FFFDC16 to 0FFFDF16
ID1 Undefined instruction vector
0FFFE016 to 0FFFE316
ID2 Overflow vector
0FFFE416 to 0FFFE716
BRK instruction vector
0FFFE816 to 0FFFEB16
ID3 Address match vector
0FFFEC16 to 0FFFEF16
ID4 Single step vector
0FFFF016 to 0FFFF316
ID5 Watchdog timer vector
0FFFF416 to 0FFFF716
ID6 DBC vector
0FFFF816 to 0FFFFB16
ID7
0FFFFC16 to 0FFFFF16
NMI vector
Reset vector
4 bytes
Figure 1.23.7. ID code store addresses
181
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Parallel I/O Mode (Flash Memory Version)
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Parallel I/O Mode
The parallel I/O mode inputs and outputs the software commands, addresses and data needed to operate
(read, program, erase, etc.) the internal flash memory. This I/O is parallel.
Use an exclusive programer supporting M30220 (flash memory version).
Refer to the instruction manual of each programer maker for the details of use.
User ROM and Boot ROM Areas
In parallel I/O mode, the user ROM and boot ROM areas shown in Figure 1.22.1 can be rewritten. Both
areas of flash memory can be operated on in the same way.
Program and block erase operations can be performed in the user ROM area. The user ROM area and its
blocks are shown in Figure 1.22.1.
The boot ROM area is 8 Kbytes in size. In parallel I/O mode, it is located at addresses 0DE00016 through
0DFFFF16. Make sure program and block erase operations are always performed within this address
range. (Access to any location outside this address range is prohibited.)
In the boot ROM area, an erase block operation is applied to only one 8 Kbyte block. The boot ROM area
has had a standard serial I/O mode control program stored in it when shipped from the Mitsubishi factory.
Therefore, using the device in standard serial input/output mode, you do not need to write to the boot
ROM area.
182
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode (Flash Memory Version)
Pin functions (Flash memory standard serial I/O mode)
Pin
Name
Description
I/O
Apply program/erase protection voltage to Vcc pin and 0 V to Vss pin.
VCC,VSS
Power input
CNVSS
CNVSS
I
Connect to VCC when VCC = 4.5V to 5.5 V.
Connect to Vpp (=4.5 V to 5.5 V) when VCC = 2.7V to 4.5 V.
RESET
Reset input
I
Reset input pin. While reset is "L" level, a 20 cycle or longer clock
must be input to XIN pin.
XIN
Clock input
I
XOUT
Clock output
O
Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal oscillator between XIN and
XOUT pins. To input an externally generated clock, input it to XIN pin
and open XOUT pin.
XCIN
Sub-clock input
I
XCOUT
Sub-clock output
O
AVCC, AVSS
Analog power supply input
VREF
Reference voltage input
I
P00 to P07
Input port P0
I
P10 to P17
Input port P1
I
P20 to P27
Input port P2
I
P30 to P35
Input port P3
I
P40 to P47
Input port P4
I
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
P50 to P57
Input port P5
I
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
P60
BUSY output
O
Standard serial mode 1: BUSY signal output pin
Standard serial mode 2: Monitors the program operation check
P61
SCLK input
I
Standard serial mode 1: Serial clock input pin
Standard serial mode 2: Input "L".
P62
RxD input
I
P63
TxD output
O
Serial data output pin
P64 to P67
Input port P6
I
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
P70 to P73,
P75, P76
Input port P7
I
P74
CE input
I
Input "H" level signal.
P77
NMI input
I
Connect this pin to Vcc.
P80 to P87
Input port P8
I
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
P90 to P97
Input port P9
I
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
P100 to P107
Input port P10
I
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
P110 to P117
Input port P11
I
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
P120 to P127
Input port P12
I
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
P130 to P132
Input port P13
I
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
SEG0 to SEG15
Segment output
O
Open when not used LCD control circuit.
COM0 to COM3
Common output
O
Open when not used LCD control circuit.
VL3 to VL1
Power supply input for LCD
Input LCD power source. Connect VL1 to VSS, VL2 to VCC, VL3 to VCC
when not used LCD control circuit.
C1 to C2
Step-up condenser
connect port
Pins in this port function as external pin for LCD step-up condenser.
Connect a condenser between C1 and C2 when used LCD voltage
multiplier. Open when not used LCD voltage multiplier.
Connect a crystal oscillator between XCIN and XCOUT pins. To input
an externally generated clock, input it to XCIN pin and open XCOUT
pin.
Connect AVSS to VSS and AVCC to VCC, respectively.
Enter the reference voltage for AD from this pin.
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
Serial data input pin
Input "H" or "L" level signal or open.
183
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
74
73
75
78
77
76
80
79
83
82
81
85
84
88
87
86
89
92
91
90
94
93
97
96
95
99
98
102
101
100
105
104
103
106
108
109
72
110
71
111
70
112
69
113
68
114
67
115
66
116
65
117
64
118
63
119
62
61
120
121
60
122
59
123
58
57
124
M30220 flash memory version
(144P6Q-A, 144PFB-A)
125
126
127
128
129
56
55
54
53
52
130
51
131
50
132
49
133
48
134
47
135
46
136
45
137
44
138
43
139
42
34
35
TxD
CE
Note1
RESET
Note2
VPP
Mode setup method
Signal
CNVss
RESET
CE
Value
4.5V to 5.5V
Vss
Vcc
Vcc
Note 1: Connect oscillator circuit.
Note 2: Connect to VCC when VCC = 4.5V to 5.5 V.
Connect to Vpp (=4.5V to 5.5 V) when VCC = 2.7V to 4.5 V.
Figure 1.25.1. Pin connections for serial I/O mode (1)
184
BUSY
RxD
SCLK
36
32
33
29
30
31
28
26
27
23
24
25
20
21
22
19
17
18
14
15
16
13
10
11
12
7
8
P15/KI5
P16/KI6
P17/KI7
P20/KI8
P21/KI9
P22/KI10
P23/KI11
P24/KI12
P25/KI13
P26/KI14
P27/KI15
P30/KI16
P31/KI17
P32/KI18
P33/KI19
P34
P35
P40/TA0OUT
P41/TA0IN
P42/TA1OUT
P43/TA1IN
P44/TA2OUT
P45/TA2IN
P46/TA3OUT/INT4
P47/TA3IN/INT4
P50/TB0IN
P51/TB1IN
P52/TB2IN
P53/TB3IN
P54/TB4IN
P55/TB5IN
P56/INT3
P57/CKOUT
P60/CTS0/RTS0
P61/CLK0
P62/RxD0
P96/AN6
P95/AN5
P94/AN4
P93/AN3
P92/AN2
P91/AN1
P90/AN0
P87/TA7IN
P86/TA7OUT
P85/TA6IN
P84/TA6OUT
P83/TA5IN
P82/TA5OUT
P81/TA4IN/INT5
P80/TA4OUT/INT5
CNVSS
XCIN
XCOUT
RESET
XOUT
VSS
XIN
VCC
P77/NMI
P76/INT2
P75/INT1
P74/INT0
P73/CTS2/RTS2
P72/CLK2
P71/RXD2/SCL
P70/TXD2/SDA
P67/TxD1
P66/RxD1
P65/CLK1
P64/CTS1/RTS1/CTS0/CLKS1
P63/TxD0
9
37
5
38
6
39
143
144
4
40
142
1
41
141
2
140
3
SEG18/P102
SEG17/P101
SEG16/P100
SEG15
SEG14
SEG13
SEG12
SEG11
SEG10
SEG9
SEG8
SEG7
SEG6
SEG5
SEG4
SEG3
SEG2
SEG1
SEG0
COM3
COM2
COM1
COM0
C2
C1
VL3
VL2
VL1
Vss
P132/DA2
P131/DA1
AVSS
P130/ADTRG/DA0
VREF
AVCC
P97/AN7
107
SEG19/P103
SEG20/P104
SEG21/P105
SEG22/P106
SEG23/P107
SEG24/P110
SEG25/P111
SEG26/P112
SEG27/P113
SEG28/P114
SEG29/P115
SEG30/P116
SEG31/P117
SEG32/P120
SEG33/P121
VSS
SEG34/P1
2V2CC
SEG35/P123
SEG36/P124
SEG37/P125
SEG38/P126
SEG39/P127
SEG40/P00
SEG41/P01
SEG42/P02
SEG43/P03
SEG44/P04
SEG45/P05
SEG46/P06
SEG47/P07
P10/KI0
P11/KI1
P12/KI2
P13/KI3
P14/KI4
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode (Flash Memory Version)
VCC
VSS
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode (Flash Memory Version)
Standard serial I/O mode
The standard serial I/O mode inputs and outputs the software commands, addresses and data needed to
operate (read, program, erase, etc.) the internal flash memory. This I/O is serial. There are actually two
standard serial I/O modes: mode 1, which is clock synchronized, and mode 2, which is asynchronized. Both
modes require a purpose-specific peripheral unit.
The standard serial I/O mode is different from the parallel I/O mode in that the CPU controls flash memory
rewrite (uses the CPU's rewrite mode), rewrite data input and so forth. The standard serial I/O mode is
_____
started by connecting “H” to the P74 (CE) pin and “H” to the CNVSS pin (when VCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V, connect
to VCC; when VCC = 2.7 V to 4.5 V, supply 4.5 V to 5.5 V to Vpp from an external source), and releasing the
reset operation. (In the ordinary command mode, set CNVss pin to "L" level.)
This control program is written in the boot ROM area when the product is shipped from Mitsubishi. Accordingly, make note of the fact that the standard serial I/O mode cannot be used if the boot ROM area is
rewritten in the parallel I/O mode. Figure 1.25.1 shows the pin connections for the standard serial I/O mode.
Serial data I/O uses UART0 and transfers the data serially in 8-bit units. Standard serial I/O switches
between mode 1 (clock synchronized) and mode 2 (clock asynchronized) according to the level of CLK0 pin
when the reset is released.
To use standard serial I/O mode 1 (clock synchronized), set the CLK0 pin to "H" level and release the reset.
The operation uses the four UART0 pins CLK0, RxD0, TxD0 and RTS0 (BUSY). The CLK0 pin is the transfer
clock input pin through which an external transfer clock is input. The TxD0 pin is for CMOS output. The
RTS0 (BUSY) pin outputs an "L" level when ready for reception and an "H" level when reception starts.
To use standard serial I/O mode 2 (clock asynchronized), set the CLK0 pin to "L" level and release the
reset. The operation uses the two UART0 pins RxD0 and TxD0.
In the standard serial I/O mode, only the user ROM area indicated in Figure 1.22.1 can be rewritten. The
boot ROM cannot.
In the standard serial I/O mode, a 7-byte ID code is used. When there is data in the flash memory, commands sent from the peripheral unit (programmer) are not accepted unless the ID code matches.
185
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Overview of standard serial I/O mode 1 (clock synchronized)
In standard serial I/O mode 1, software commands, addresses and data are input and output between the
MCU and peripheral units (serial programer, etc.) using 4-wire clock-synchronized serial I/O (UART0).
Standard serial I/O mode 1 is engaged by releasing the reset with the P61 (CLK0) pin "H" level.
In reception, software commands, addresses and program data are synchronized with the rise of the
transfer clock that is input to the CLK0 pin, and are then input to the MCU via the RxD0 pin. In transmission, the read data and status are synchronized with the fall of the transfer clock, and output from the
TxD0 pin.
The TxD0 pin is for CMOS output. Transfer is in 8-bit units with LSB first.
When busy, such as during transmission, reception, erasing or program execution, the RTS0 (BUSY) pin
is "H" level. Accordingly, always start the next transfer after the RTS0 (BUSY) pin is "L" level.
Also, data and status registers in memory can be read after inputting software commands. Status, such
as the operating state of the flash memory or whether a program or erase operation ended successfully or
not, can be checked by reading the status register. Here following are explained software commands,
status registers, etc.
186
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Software Commands
Table 1.25.1 lists software commands. In the standard serial I/O mode 1, erase operations, programs and
reading are controlled by transferring software commands via the RxD0 pin. Software commands are
explained here below.
Table 1.25.1. Software commands (Standard serial I/O mode 1)
Control command
1st byte
transfer
2nd byte
3rd byte
4th byte 5th byte 6th byte
1
Page read
FF16
Address
(middle)
Address
(high)
Data
output
Data
output
Data
output
Data
output to
259th byte
2
Page program
4116
Address
(middle)
Address
(high)
Data
input
Data
input
Data
input
Data input
to 259th
byte
3
Block erase
2016
Address
(high)
D016
4
Erase all blocks
A716
Address
(middle)
D016
5
Read status register
7016
SRD
output
SRD1
output
6
Clear status register
5016
7
Code processing function
8
9
When ID is
not verified
Not
acceptable
Not
acceptable
Not
acceptable
Not
acceptable
Acceptable
Not
acceptable
F516
Address
(low)
Download function
Address
(middle)
Size
FA16 Size (low)
(high)
Version data output function
FB16
Version
data
output
Version
data
output
Version
data
output
10 Boot ROM area output
function
FC16
Address
(middle)
Address
(high)
Data
output
11 Read check data
Check
FD16 data (low)
Check
data
(high)
Address
(high)
Checksum
ID size
ID1
To
Data required
input number
of times
Version Version
data
data
output output
Data
output
Data
output
To ID7
Version
data
output to
9th byte
Data
output to
259th
byte
Acceptable
Not
acceptable
Acceptable
Not
acceptable
Not
acceptable
Note 1: Shading indicates transfer from flash memory microcomputer to peripheral unit. All other data is transferred from the peripheral unit to the flash memory microcomputer.
Note 2: SRD refers to status register data. SRD1 refers to status register 1 data.
Note 3: All commands can be accepted when the flash memory is totally blank.
187
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Page Read Command
This command reads the specified page (256 bytes) in the flash memory sequentially one byte at a
time. Execute the page read command as explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “FF16” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A8 to A15 and A16 to A23 with the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
(3) From the 4th byte onward, data (D0–D7) for the page (256 bytes) specified with addresses A8 to
A23 will be output sequentially from the smallest address first in sync with the rise of the clock.
CLK0
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
FF16
A8 to
A15
A16 to
A23
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
data255
data0
RTS0(BUSY)
Figure 1.25.2. Timing for page read
Read Status Register Command
This command reads status information. When the “7016” command code is sent with the 1st byte, the
contents of the status register (SRD) specified with the 2nd byte and the contents of status register 1
(SRD1) specified with the 3rd byte are read.
CLK0
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
7016
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
RTS0(BUSY)
Figure 1.25.3. Timing for reading the status register
188
SRD
output
SRD1
output
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Clear Status Register Command
This command clears the bits (SR4–SR5) which are set when the status register operation ends in
error. When the “5016” command code is sent with the 1st byte, the aforementioned bits are cleared.
When the clear status register operation ends, the RTS0 (BUSY) signal changes from the “H” to the
“L” level.
CLK0
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
5016
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
RTS0(BUSY)
Figure 1.25.4. Timing for clearing the status register
Page Program Command
This command writes the specified page (256 bytes) in the flash memory sequentially one byte at a
time. Execute the page program command as explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “4116” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A8 to A15 and A16 to A23 with the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
(3) From the 4th byte onward, as write data (D0–D7) for the page (256 bytes) specified with addresses
A8 to A23 is input sequentially from the smallest address first, that page is automatically written.
When reception setup for the next 256 bytes ends, the RTS0 (BUSY) signal changes from the “H” to
the “L” level. The result of the page program can be known by reading the status register. For more
information, see the section on the status register.
CLK0
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
4116
A8 to
A15
A16 to
A23
data0
data255
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
RTS0(BUSY)
Figure 1.25.5. Timing for the page program
189
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Block Erase Command
This command erases the data in the specified block. Execute the block erase command as explained
here following.
(1) Transfer the “2016” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A8 to A15 and A16 to A23 with the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
(3) Transfer the verify command code “D016” with the 4th byte. With the verify command code, the
erase operation will start for the specified block in the flash memory. Write the highest address of
the specified block for addresses A8 to A23.
When block erasing ends, the RTS0 (BUSY) signal changes from the “H” to the “L” level. After block
erase ends, the result of the block erase operation can be known by reading the status register. For
more information, see the section on the status register.
CLK0
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
2016
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
RTS0(BUSY)
Figure 1.25.6. Timing for block erasing
190
A8 to
A15
A16 to
A23
D016
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Erase All Blocks Command
This command erases the content of all blocks. Execute the erase all blocks command as explained
here following.
(1) Transfer the “A716” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer the verify command code “D016” with the 2nd byte. With the verify command code, the
erase operation will start and continue for all blocks in the flash memory.
When block erasing ends, the RTS0 (BUSY) signal changes from the “H” to the “L” level. The result of the
erase operation can be known by reading the status register.
CLK0
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
A716
D016
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
RTS0(BUSY)
Figure 1.25.7. Timing for erasing all blocks
Download Command
This command downloads a program to the RAM for execution. Execute the download command as
explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “FA16” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer the program size with the 2nd and 3rd bytes.
(3) Transfer the check sum with the 4th byte. The check sum is added to all data sent with the 5th
byte onward.
(4) The program to execute is sent with the 5th byte onward.
When all data has been transmitted, if the check sum matches, the downloaded program is executed.
The size of the program will vary according to the internal RAM.
CLK0
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
FA16
Check
sum
Program
data
Program
data
Data size (low)
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
Data size (high)
RTS0(BUSY)
Figure 1.25.8. Timing for download
191
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Version Information Output Command
This command outputs the version information of the control program stored in the boot area. Execute
the version information output command as explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “FB16” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) The version information will be output from the 2nd byte onward. This data is composed of 8
ASCII code characters.
CLK0
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
FB16
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
'V'
'E'
'R'
'X'
RTS0(BUSY)
Figure 1.25.9. Timing for version information output
Boot ROM Area Output Command
This command outputs the control program stored in the boot ROM area in one page blocks (256
bytes). Execute the boot ROM area output command as explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “FC16” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A8 to A15 and A16 to A23 with the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
(3) From the 4th byte onward, data (D0–D7) for the page (256 bytes) specified with addresses A8 to
A23 will be output sequentially from the smallest address first, in sync with the rise of the clock.
CLK0
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
FC16
A8 to
A15
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
RTS0(BUSY)
Figure 1.25.10. Timing for boot ROM area output
192
A16 to
A23
data0
data255
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
ID Check
This command checks the ID code. Execute the boot ID check command as explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “F516” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A0 to A7, A8 to A15 and A16 to A23 of the 1st byte of the ID code with the 2nd,
3rd and 4th bytes respectively.
(3) Transfer the number of data sets of the ID code with the 5th byte.
(4) The ID code is sent with the 6th byte onward, starting with the 1st byte of the code.
CLK0
RxD0
(M16C reception
data)
F516
DF16
FF16
0F16
ID size
ID1
ID7
TxD0
(M16C transmit
data)
RTS0(BUSY)
Figure 1.25.11. Timing for the ID check
ID Code
When the flash memory is not blank, the ID code sent from the peripheral units and the ID code written
in the flash memory are compared to see if they match. If the codes do not match, the command sent
from the peripheral units is not accepted. An ID code contains 8 bits of data. Area is, from the 1st byte,
addresses 0FFFDF16, 0FFFE316, 0FFFEB16, 0FFFEF16, 0FFFF316, 0FFFF716 and 0FFFFB16. Write
a program into the flash memory, which already has the ID code set for these addresses.
Address
0FFFDC16 to 0FFFDF16
ID1 Undefined instruction vector
0FFFE016 to 0FFFE316
ID2 Overflow vector
0FFFE416 to 0FFFE716
BRK instruction vector
0FFFE816 to 0FFFEB16
ID3 Address match vector
0FFFEC16 to 0FFFEF16
ID4 Single step vector
0FFFF016 to 0FFFF316
ID5 Watchdog timer vector
0FFFF416 to 0FFFF716
ID6 DBC vector
0FFFF816 to 0FFFFB16
ID7
0FFFFC16 to 0FFFFF16
NMI vector
Reset vector
4 bytes
Figure 1.25.12. ID code storage addresses
193
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Read Check Data
This command reads the check data that confirms that the write data, which was sent with the page
program command, was successfully received.
(1) Transfer the "FD16" command code with the 1st byte.
(2) The check data (low) is received with the 2nd byte and the check data (high) with the 3rd.
To use this read check data command, first execute the command and then initialize the check data.
Next, execute the page program command the required number of times. After that, when the read
check command is executed again, the check data for all of the read data that was sent with the page
program command during this time is read. Check data adds write data in 1 byte units and obtains the
two’s-compliment of the insignificant 2 bytes of the accumulated data.
CLK0
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
FD16
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
Check data (low)
RTS0(BUSY)
Figure 1.25.13. Timing for the read check data
194
Check data (high)
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Status Register (SRD)
The status register indicates operating status of the flash memory and status such as whether an erase
operation or a program ended successfully or in error. It can be read by writing the read status register
command (7016). Also, the status register is cleared by writing the clear status register command (5016).
Table 1.25.2 gives the definition of each status register bit. After clearing the reset, the status register
outputs “8016”.
Table 1.25.2. Status register (SRD)
Definition
SRD0 bits
Status name
"1"
SR7 (bit7)
Sequencer status
Ready
Busy
SR6 (bit6)
Reserved
-
-
SR5 (bit5)
Erase status
Terminated in error
Terminated normally
SR4 (bit4)
Program status
Terminated in error
Terminated normally
SR3 (bit3)
Reserved
-
-
SR2 (bit2)
Reserved
-
-
SR1 (bit1)
Reserved
-
-
SR0 (bit0)
Reserved
-
-
"0"
Sequencer status (SR7)
After power-on, the sequencer status is set to 1(ready).
The sequencer status indicates the operating status of the device. This status bit is set to 0 (busy)
during write or erase operation and is set to 1 upon completion of these operations.
Erase Status (SR5)
The erase status reports the operating status of the auto erase operation. If an erase error occurs, it is
set to “1”. When the erase status is cleared, it is set to “0”.
Program Status (SR4)
The program status reports the operating status of the auto write operation. If a write error occurs, it is
set to “1”. When the program status is cleared, it is set to “0”.
195
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Status Register 1 (SRD1)
Status register 1 indicates the status of serial communications, results from ID checks and results from
check sum comparisons. It can be read after the SRD by writing the read status register command (7016).
Also, status register 1 is cleared by writing the clear status register command (5016).
Table 1.25.3 gives the definition of each status register 1 bit. “0016” is output when power is turned ON
and the flag status is maintained even after the reset.
Table 1.25.3. Status register 1 (SRD1)
Definition
SRD1 bits
Status name
"1"
"0"
SR15 (bit7)
Boot update completed bit
Update completed
Not update
SR14 (bit6)
Reserved
-
-
SR13 (bit5)
Reserved
-
-
SR12 (bit4)
Checksum match bit
SR11 (bit3)
ID check completed bits
Match
00
01
10
11
SR10 (bit2)
Mismatch
Not verified
Verification mismatch
Reserved
Verified
SR9 (bit1)
Data receive time out
Time out
Normal operation
SR8 (bit0)
Reserved
-
-
Boot Update Completed Bit (SR15)
This flag indicates whether the control program was downloaded to the RAM or not, using the download function.
Check Sum Consistency Bit (SR12)
This flag indicates whether the check sum matches or not when a program, is downloaded for execution using the download function.
ID Check Completed Bits (SR11 and SR10)
These flags indicate the result of ID checks. Some commands cannot be accepted without an ID
check.
Data Reception Time Out (SR9)
This flag indicates when a time out error is generated during data reception. If this flag is attached
during data reception, the received data is discarded and the microcomputer returns to the command
wait state.
196
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Full Status Check
Results from executed erase and program operations can be known by running a full status check. Figure
1.25.14 shows a flowchart of the full status check and explains how to remedy errors which occur.
Read status register
YES
Command
sequence error
Execute the clear status register command (5016)
to clear the status register. Try performing the
operation one more time after confirming that the
command is entered correctly.
NO
Block erase error
Should a block erase error occur, the block in error
cannot be used.
NO
Program error
SR4=1 and SR5
=1 ?
NO
SR5=0?
YES
SR4=0?
Should a program error occur, the block in error
cannot be used.
YES
End (block erase, program)
Note: When one of SR5 to SR4 is set to 1, none of the program, erase all blocks, and
block erase commands is accepted. Execute the clear status register command
(5016) before executing these commands.
Figure 1.25.14. Full status check flowchart and remedial procedure for errors
197
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 (Flash Memory Version)
Example Circuit Application for The Standard Serial I/O Mode 1
The below figure shows a circuit application for the standard serial I/O mode 1. Control pins will vary
according to programmer, therefore see the peripheral unit manual for more information.
Clock input
BUSY output
CLK0
RTS0(BUSY)
Data input
RXD0
Data output
TXD0
M30220 flash
VPP power
source input
CNVss
NMI
P74(CE)
(1) Control pins and external circuitry will vary according to peripheral unit. For more information,
see the peripheral unit manual.
(2) In this example, the Vpp power supply is supplied from an external source (writer). To use the
user's power source, connect to 4.5V to 5.5 V.
Figure 1.25.15. Example circuit application for the standard serial I/O mode 1
198
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Overview of standard serial I/O mode 2 (clock asynchronized)
In standard serial I/O mode 2, software commands, addresses and data are input and output between the
MCU and peripheral units (serial programer, etc.) using 2-wire clock-asynchronized serial I/O (UART0).
Standard serial I/O mode 2 is engaged by releasing the reset with the P61 (CLK0) pin "L" level.
The TxD0 pin is for CMOS output. Data transfer is in 8-bit units with LSB first, 1 stop bit and parity OFF.
After the reset is released, connections can be established at 9,600 bps when initial communications (Figure 1.25.16) are made with a peripheral unit. However, this requires a main clock with a minimum 2 MHz
input oscillation frequency. Baud rate can also be changed from 9,600 bps to 19,200, 38,400 or 57,600 bps
by executing software commands. However, communication errors may occur because of the oscillation
frequency of the main clock. If errors occur, change the main clock's oscillation frequency and the baud
rate.
After executing commands from a peripheral unit that requires time to erase and write data, as with erase
and program commands, allow a sufficient time interval or execute the read status command and check
how processing ended, before executing the next command.
Data and status registers in memory can be read after transmitting software commands. Status, such as
the operating state of the flash memory or whether a program or erase operation ended successfully or not,
can be checked by reading the status register. Here following are explained initial communications with
peripheral units, how frequency is identified and software commands.
Initial communications with peripheral units
After the reset is released, the bit rate generator is adjusted to 9,600 bps to match the oscillation frequency of the main clock, by sending the code as prescribed by the protocol for initial communications
with peripheral units (Figure 1.25.16).
(1) Transmit "B016" from a peripheral unit. If the oscillation frequency input by the main clock is 10 MHz,
the MCU with internal flash memory outputs the "B016" check code. If the oscillation frequency is
anything other than 10 MHz, the MCU does not output anything.
(2) Transmit "0016" from a peripheral unit 16 times. (The MCU with internal flash memory sets the bit
rate generator so that "0016" can be successfully received.)
(3) The MCU with internal flash memory outputs the "B016" check code and initial communications end
successfully *1. Initial communications must be transmitted at a speed of 9,600 bps and a transfer
interval of a minimum 15 ms. Also, the baud rate at the end of initial communications is 9,600 bps.
*1. If the peripheral unit cannot receive "B016" successfully, change the oscillation frequency of the main clock.
MCU with internal
flash memory
Peripheral unit
Reset
(1) Transfer "B016"
"B016"
(2) Transfer "0016" 16 times
At least 15ms
transfer interval
"B016"
1st
"0016"
2nd
"0016"
15 th
"0016"
16th
"0016"
"B016"
If the oscillation frequency input
by the main clock is 10 MHz, the
MCU outputs "B016". If other than
10 MHz, the MCU does not
output anything.
(3) Transfer check code "B016"
The bit rate generator setting completes (9600bps)
Figure 1.25.16. Peripheral unit and initial communication
199
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
How frequency is identified
When "0016" data is received 16 times from a peripheral unit at a baud rate of 9,600 bps, the value of the
bit rate generator is set to match the operating frequency (2 - 10 MHz). The highest speed is taken from
the first 8 transmissions and the lowest from the last 8. These values are then used to calculate the bit
rate generator value for a baud rate of 9,600 bps.
Baud rate cannot be attained with some operating frequencies. Table 1.25.4 gives the operation frequency and the baud rate that can be attained for.
Table 1.25.4 Operation frequency and the baud rate
Operation frequency
(MHZ)
Baud rate
9,600bps
Baud rate
38,400bps
Baud rate
57,600bps
10MHZ
√
√
–
√
8MHZ
√
√
–
√
7.3728MHZ
√
√
√
√
6MHZ
√
√
√
–
5MHZ
√
√
–
–
4.5MHZ
√
√
–
√
4.194304MHZ
√
√
√
–
4MHZ
√
√
–
–
3.58MHZ
√
√
√
√
3MHZ
√
√
√
–
2MHZ
√
–
–
–
√ : Communications possible
– : Communications not possible
200
Baud rate
19,200bps
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Software Commands
Table 1.25.5 lists software commands. In the standard serial I/O mode 2, erase operations, programs and
reading are controlled by transferring software commands via the RxD0 pin. Standard serial I/O mode 2
adds four transmission speed commands - 9,600, 19,200, 38,400 and 57,600 bps - to the software commands of standard serial I/O mode 1. Software commands are explained here below.
Table 1.25.5. Software commands (Standard serial I/O mode 2)
Control command
1st byte
transfer
2nd byte
3rd byte
4th byte 5th byte 6th byte
1
Page read
FF16
Address
(middle)
Address
(high)
Data
output
Data
output
Data
output
2
Page program
4116
Address
(middle)
Address
(high)
Data
input
Data
input
Data
input
3
Block erase
2016
Address
(high)
D016
4
Erase all unlocked blocks
A716
Address
(middle)
D016
5
Read status register
7016
SRD
output
SRD1
output
6
Clear status register
5016
7
Code processing function
8
9
Not
acceptable
Not
acceptable
Not
acceptable
Acceptable
Not
acceptable
F516
Address
(low)
Download function
Address
(middle)
Size
FA16 Size (low)
(high)
Version data output function
FB16
Version
data
output
Version
data
output
Version
data
output
FC16
Address
(middle)
Address
(high)
Data
output
10 Boot ROM area output
function
Data
output to
259th byte
Data input
to 259th
byte
When ID is
not verified
Not
acceptable
Address
(high)
Checksum
ID size
ID1
To
Data required
input number
of times
Version Version
data
data
output output
Data
output
Data
output
To ID7
Version
data
output to
9th byte
Data
output to
259th byte
Acceptable
Not
acceptable
Acceptable
Not
acceptable
11 Read check data
Check
FD16 data (low)
12 Baud rate 9600
B016
B016
Acceptable
13 Baud rate 19200
B116
B116
Acceptable
14 Baud rate 38400
B216
B216
Acceptable
15 Baud rate 57600
B316
B316
Acceptable
Check
data
(high)
Not
acceptable
Note 1: Shading indicates transfer from flash memory microcomputer to peripheral unit. All other data is transferred from the peripheral unit to the flash memory microcomputer.
Note 2: SRD refers to status register data. SRD1 refers to status register 1 data.
Note 3: All commands can be accepted when the flash memory is totally blank.
201
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Page Read Command
This command reads the specified page (256 bytes) in the flash memory sequentially one byte at a
time. Execute the page read command as explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “FF16” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A8 to A15 and A16 to A23 with the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
(3) From the 4th byte onward, data (D0–D7) for the page (256 bytes) specified with addresses A8 to
A23 will be output sequentially from the smallest address first in sync with the rise of the clock.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
FF16
A8 to
A15
A16 to
A23
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
data0
data255
Figure 1.25.17. Timing for page read
Read Status Register Command
This command reads status information. When the “7016” command code is sent with the 1st byte, the
contents of the status register (SRD) specified with the 2nd byte and the contents of status register 1
(SRD1) specified with the 3rd byte are read.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
7016
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
Figure 1.25.18. Timing for reading the status register
202
SRD
output
SRD1
output
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Clear Status Register Command
This command clears the bits (SR4–SR5) which are set when the status register operation ends in
error. When the “5016” command code is sent with the 1st byte, the aforementioned bits are cleared.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
5016
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
Figure 1.25.19. Timing for clearing the status register
Page Program Command
This command writes the specified page (256 bytes) in the flash memory sequentially one byte at a
time. Execute the page program command as explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “4116” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A8 to A15 and A16 to A23 with the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
(3) From the 4th byte onward, as write data (D0–D7) for the page (256 bytes) specified with addresses
A8 to A23 is input sequentially from the smallest address first, that page is automatically written.
The result of the page program can be known by reading the status register. For more information,
see the section on the status register.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
4116
A8 to
A15
A16 to
A23
data0
data255
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
Figure 1.25.20. Timing for the page program
203
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Block Erase Command
This command erases the data in the specified block. Execute the block erase command as explained
here following.
(1) Transfer the “2016” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A8 to A15 and A16 to A23 with the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
(3) Transfer the verify command code “D016” with the 4th byte. With the verify command code, the
erase operation will start for the specified block in the flash memory. Write the highest address of
the specified block for addresses A16 to A23.
After block erase ends, the result of the block erase operation can be known by reading the status
register. For more information, see the section on the status register.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
2016
A8 to
A15
A16 to
A23
D016
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
Figure 1.25.21. Timing for block erasing
Erase All Blocks Command
This command erases the content of all blocks. Execute the erase all blocks command as explained
here following.
(1) Transfer the “A716” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer the verify command code “D016” with the 2nd byte. With the verify command code, the
erase operation will start and continue for all blocks in the flash memory.
The result of the erase operation can be known by reading the status register.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
Figure 1.25.22. Timing for erasing all blocks
204
A716
D016
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Download Command
This command downloads a program to the RAM for execution. Execute the download command as
explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “FA16” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer the program size with the 2nd and 3rd bytes.
(3) Transfer the check sum with the 4th byte. The check sum is added to all data sent with the 5th
byte onward.
(4) The program to execute is sent with the 5th byte onward.
When all data has been transmitted, if the check sum matches, the downloaded program is executed.
The size of the program will vary according to the internal RAM.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
FA16
Check
sum
Program
data
Program
data
Data size (low)
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
Data size (high)
Figure 1.25.23. Timing for download
205
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Version Information Output Command
This command outputs the version information of the control program stored in the boot area. Execute
the version information output command as explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “FB16” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) The version information will be output from the 2nd byte onward. This data is composed of 8
ASCII code characters.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
FB16
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
'V'
'E'
'R'
'X'
Figure 1.25.24. Timing for version information output
Boot ROM Area Output Command
This command outputs the control program stored in the boot ROM area in one page blocks (256
bytes). Execute the boot ROM area output command as explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “FC16” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A8 to A15 and A16 to A23 with the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
(3) From the 4th byte onward, data (D0–D7) for the page (256 bytes) specified with addresses A8 to
A23 will be output sequentially from the smallest address first, in sync with the rise of the clock.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
FC16
A8 to
A15
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
Figure 1.25.25. Timing for boot ROM area output
206
A16 to
A23
data0
data255
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
ID Check
This command checks the ID code. Execute the boot ID check command as explained here following.
(1) Transfer the “F516” command code with the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A0 to A7, A8 to A15 and A16 to A23 of the 1st byte of the ID code with the 2nd,
3rd and 4th bytes respectively.
(3) Transfer the number of data sets of the ID code with the 5th byte.
(4) The ID code is sent with the 6th byte onward, starting with the 1st byte of the code.
RxD0
(M16C reception
data)
F516
DF16
FF16
0F16
ID size
ID1
ID7
TxD0
(M16C transmit
data)
Figure 1.25.26. Timing for the ID check
ID Code
When the flash memory is not blank, the ID code sent from the peripheral units and the ID code written
in the flash memory are compared to see if they match. If the codes do not match, the command sent
from the peripheral units is not accepted. An ID code contains 8 bits of data. Area is, from the 1st byte,
addresses 0FFFDF16, 0FFFE316, 0FFFEB16, 0FFFEF16, 0FFFF316, 0FFFF716 and 0FFFFB16. Write
a program into the flash memory, which already has the ID code set for these addresses.
Address
0FFFDC16 to 0FFFDF16
ID1 Undefined instruction vector
0FFFE016 to 0FFFE316
ID2 Overflow vector
0FFFE416 to 0FFFE716
BRK instruction vector
0FFFE816 to 0FFFEB16
ID3 Address match vector
0FFFEC16 to 0FFFEF16
ID4 Single step vector
0FFFF016 to 0FFFF316
ID5 Watchdog timer vector
0FFFF416 to 0FFFF716
ID6 DBC vector
0FFFF816 to 0FFFFB16
ID7
0FFFFC16 to 0FFFFF16
NMI vector
Reset vector
4 bytes
Figure 1.25.27. ID code storage addresses
207
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Read Check Data
This command reads the check data that confirms that the write data, which was sent with the page
program command, was successfully received.
(1) Transfer the "FD16" command code with the 1st byte.
(2) The check data (low) is received with the 2nd byte and the check data (high) with the 3rd.
To use this read check data command, first execute the command and then initialize the check data.
Next, execute the page program command the required number of times. After that, when the read
check command is executed again, the check data for all of the read data that was sent with the page
program command during this time is read. Check data adds write data in 1 byte units and obtains the
two’s-compliment of the insignificant 2 bytes of the accumulated data.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
FD16
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
Check data (low)
Check data (high)
Figure 1.25.28. Timing for the read check data
Baud Rate 9600
This command changes baud rate to 9,600 bps. Execute it as follows.
(1) Transfer the "B016" command code with the 1st byte.
(2) After the "B016" check code is output with the 2nd byte, change the baud rate to 9,600 bps.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
B016
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
Figure 1.25.29. Timing of baud rate 9600
208
B016
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
M30220 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Baud Rate 19200
This command changes baud rate to 19,200 bps. Execute it as follows.
(1) Transfer the "B116" command code with the 1st byte.
(2) After the "B116" check code is output with the 2nd byte, change the baud rate to 19,200 bps.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
B116
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
B116
Figure 1.25.30. Timing of baud rate 19200
Baud Rate 38400
This command changes baud rate to 38,400 bps. Execute it as follows.
(1) Transfer the "B216" command code with the 1st byte.
(2) After the "B216" check code is output with the 2nd byte, change the baud rate to 38,400 bps.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
B216
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
B216
Figure 1.25.31. Timing of baud rate 38400
Baud Rate 57600
This command changes baud rate to 57,600 bps. Execute it as follows.
(1) Transfer the "B316" command code with the 1st byte.
(2) After the "B316" check code is output with the 2nd byte, change the baud rate to 57,600 bps.
RxD0
(M16C reception data)
B316
TxD0
(M16C transmit data)
B316
Figure 1.25.32. Timing of baud rate 57600
209
t
U
de nd
ve er
lo
pm
en
Preliminary Specifications REV.E
Mitsubishi microcomputers
M30220 Group
Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change.
Appendix Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 (Flash Memory Version)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Example Circuit Application for The Standard Serial I/O Mode 2
The below figure shows a circuit application for the standard serial I/O mode 2.
CLK0
Monitor output
BUSY
Data input
RXD0
Data output
TXD0
M30220 flash
VPP power
source input
CNVss
NMI
P74(CE)
(1) In this example, the Vpp power supply is supplied from an external source (writer). To use the
user's power source, connect to 4.5V to 5.5 V.
Figure 1.25.23. Example circuit application for the standard serial I/O mode 2
210
Keep safety first in your circuit designs!
●
Mitsubishi Electric Corporation puts the maximum effort into making semiconductor
products better and more reliable, but there is always the possibility that trouble may
occur with them. Trouble with semiconductors may lead to personal injury, fire or
property damage. Remember to give due consideration to safety when making your
circuit designs, with appropriate measures such as (i) placement of substitutive,
auxiliary circuits, (ii) use of non-flammable material or (iii) prevention against any
malfunction or mishap.
Notes regarding these materials
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
These materials are intended as a reference to assist our customers in the selection
of the Mitsubishi semiconductor product best suited to the customer's application;
they do not convey any license under any intellectual property rights, or any other
rights, belonging to Mitsubishi Electric Corporation or a third party.
Mitsubishi Electric Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, or
infringement of any third-party's rights, originating in the use of any product data,
diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, or circuit application examples contained in
these materials.
All information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts,
programs and algorithms represents information on products at the time of publication
of these materials, and are subject to change by Mitsubishi Electric Corporation
without notice due to product improvements or other reasons. It is therefore
recommended that customers contact Mitsubishi Electric Corporation or an authorized
Mitsubishi Semiconductor product distributor for the latest product information before
purchasing a product listed herein.
The information described here may contain technical inaccuracies or typographical
errors. Mitsubishi Electric Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage,
liability, or other loss rising from these inaccuracies or errors.
Please also pay attention to information published by Mitsubishi Electric Corporation
by various means, including the Mitsubishi Semiconductor home page (http://
www.mitsubishichips.com).
When using any or all of the information contained in these materials, including
product data, diagrams, charts, programs, and algorithms, please be sure to evaluate
all information as a total system before making a final decision on the applicability of
the information and products. Mitsubishi Electric Corporation assumes no
responsibility for any damage, liability or other loss resulting from the information
contained herein.
Mitsubishi Electric Corporation semiconductors are not designed or manufactured
for use in a device or system that is used under circumstances in which human life is
potentially at stake. Please contact Mitsubishi Electric Corporation or an authorized
Mitsubishi Semiconductor product distributor when considering the use of a product
contained herein for any specific purposes, such as apparatus or systems for
transportation, vehicular, medical, aerospace, nuclear, or undersea repeater use.
The prior written approval of Mitsubishi Electric Corporation is necessary to reprint
or reproduce in whole or in part these materials.
If these products or technologies are subject to the Japanese export control
restrictions, they must be exported under a license from the Japanese government
and cannot be imported into a country other than the approved destination.
Any diversion or reexport contrary to the export control laws and regulations of Japan
and/or the country of destination is prohibited.
Please contact Mitsubishi Electric Corporation or an authorized Mitsubishi Semicon
ductor product distributor for further details on these materials or the products con
tained therein.
MITSUBISHI SEMICONDUCTORS
M30220 Group Specification REV.E
Oct. First Edition 1999
Editioned by
Committee of editing of Mitsubishi Semiconductor
Published by
Mitsubishi Electric Corp., Kitaitami Works
This book, or parts thereof, may not be reproduced in any form without
permission of Mitsubishi Electric Corporation.
©1999 MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC CORPORATION